Академический Документы
Профессиональный Документы
Культура Документы
PIC16F87X
Pin Diagram PDIP
MCLR/VPP/THV RA0/AN0 RA1/AN1 RA2/AN2/VREFRA3/AN3/VREF+ RA4/T0CKI RA5/AN4/SS RE0/RD/AN5 RE1/WR/AN6 RE2/CS/AN7 VDD VSS OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 RC2/CCP1 RC3/SCK/SCL RD0/PSP0 RD1/PSP1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 RB7/PGD RB6/PGC RB5 RB4 RB3/PGM RB2 RB1 RB0/INT VDD VSS RD7/PSP7 RD6/PSP6 RD5/PSP5 RD4/PSP4 RC7/RX/DT RC6/TX/CK RC5/SDO RC4/SDI/SDA RD3/PSP3 RD2/PSP2
PIC16F877/874
Peripheral Features:
Timer0: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit prescaler Timer1: 16-bit timer/counter with prescaler, can be incremented during sleep via external crystal/clock Timer2: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit period register, prescaler and postscaler Two Capture, Compare, PWM modules Capture is 16-bit, max. resolution is 12.5 ns, Compare is 16-bit, max. resolution is 200 ns, PWM max. resolution is 10-bit 5 10-bit multi-channel Analog-to-Digital converter 5 Synchronous Serial Port (SSP) with SPI (Master Mode) and I2C (Master/Slave) 5 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART/SCI) with 9-bit address detection Parallel Slave Port (PSP) 8-bits wide, with external RD, WR and CS controls (40/44-pin only) Brown-out detection circuitry for Brown-out Reset (BOR)
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 1
PIC16F87X
Pin Diagrams DIP, SOIC
MCLR/VPP/THV RA0/AN0 RA1/AN1 RA2/AN2/VREFRA3/AN3/VREF+ RA4/T0CKI RA5/AN4/SS VSS OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 RC2/CCP1 RC3/SCK/SCL 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 RB7/PGD RB6/PGC RB5 RB4 RB3/PGM RB2 RB1 RB0/INT VDD VSS RC7/RX/DT RC6/TX/CK RC5/SDO RC4/SDI/SDA RA3/AN3/VREF+ RA2/AN2/VREFRA1/AN1 RA0/AN0 MCLR/VPP/THV NC RB7/PGD RB6/PGC RB5 RB4 NC 6 5 4 3 2 1 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 9
PIC16F876/873
PLCC
RC6/TX/CK RC5/SDO RC4/SDI/SDA RD3/PSP3 RD2/PSP2 RD1/PSP1 RD0/PSP0 RC3/SCK/SCL RC2/CCP1 RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 NC
QFP
44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
RC7/RX/DT RD4/PSP4 RD5/PSP5 RD6/PSP6 RD7/PSP7 VSS VDD RB0/INT RB1 RB2 RB3/PGM
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
PIC16F877 PIC16F874
33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23
NC RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI OSC2/CLKOUT OSC1/CLKIN VSS VDD RE2/AN7/CS RE1/AN6/WR RE0/AN5/RD RA5/AN4 RA4/T0CKI
DS30292A-page 2
Preliminary
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 RC2/CCP1 RC3/SCK/SCL RD0/PSP0 RD1/PSP1 RD2/PSP2 RD3/PSP3 RC4/SDI/SDA RC5/SDO RC6/TX/CK NC
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 282
RA4/T0CKI RA5/AN4/SS RE0/RD/AN5 RE1/WR/AN6 RE2/CS/AN7 VDD VSS OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT RC0/T1OSO/T1CK1 NC
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
PIC16F877 PIC16F874
RB3/PGM RB2 RB1 RB0/INT VDD VSS RD7/PSP7 RD6/PSP6 RD5/PSP5 RD4/PSP4 RC7/RX/DT
PIC16F87X
Key Features PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual (DS33023) Operating Frequency Resets (and Delays) FLASH Program Memory (14-bit words) Data Memory (bytes) EEPROM Data Memory Interrupts I/O Ports Timers Capture/Compare/PWM modules Serial Communications Parallel Communications 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Module Instruction Set
PIC16F873 DC - 20 MHz POR, BOR (PWRT, OST) 4K 192 128 13 Ports A,B,C 3 2 MSSP, USART 5 input channels 35 Instructions
PIC16F874 DC - 20 MHz POR, BOR (PWRT, OST) 4K 192 128 14 Ports A,B,C,D,E 3 2 MSSP, USART PSP 8 input channels 35 Instructions
PIC16F876 DC - 20 MHz POR, BOR (PWRT, OST) 8K 368 256 13 Ports A,B,C 3 2 MSSP, USART 5 input channels 35 Instructions
PIC16F877 DC - 20 MHz POR, BOR (PWRT, OST) 8K 368 256 14 Ports A,B,C,D,E 3 2 MSSP, USART PSP 8 input channels 35 Instructions
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 3
PIC16F87X
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 5 2.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................. 11 3.0 I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 29 4.0 Data EEPROM and FLASH Program Memory .......................................................................................................................... 41 5.0 Timer0 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 47 6.0 Timer1 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 49 7.0 Timer2 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 53 8.0 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Module(s) ................................................................................................................................. 55 9.0 Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Module ...................................................................................................................... 61 10.0 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART)................................................................................... 105 11.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) Module................................................................................................................................ 121 12.0 Special Features of the CPU.................................................................................................................................................... 133 13.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 151 14.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 153 15.0 Electrical Characteristics .......................................................................................................................................................... 157 16.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables....................................................................................................................... 177 17.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 179 Appendix A: Revision History......................................................................................................................................................... 187 Appendix B: Device Differences..................................................................................................................................................... 187 Appendix C: Conversion Considerations........................................................................................................................................ 187 Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 191
Errata
An errata sheet may exist for current devices, describing minor operational differences (from the data sheet) and recommended workarounds. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision of silicon and revision of document to which it applies. To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following: Microchips Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com Your local Microchip sales ofce (see last page) The Microchip Corporate Literature Center; U.S. FAX: (602) 786-7277 When contacting a sales ofce or the literature center, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are using.
DS30292A-page 4
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
1.0 DEVICE OVERVIEW
This document contains device-specic information. Additional information may be found in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023), which may be obtained from your local Microchip Sales Representative or downloaded from the Microchip website. The Reference Manual should be considered a complementary document to this data sheet, and is highly recommended reading for a better understanding of the device architecture and operation of the peripheral modules. There a four devices (PIC16F873, PIC16F874, PIC16F876, and PIC16F877) covered by this data sheet. The PIC16F876/873 devices come in 28-pin packages and the PIC16F877/874 devices come in 40pin packages. The 28-pin devices do not have a Parallel Slave Port implemented. The following two gures are device block diagrams sorted by pin number; 28-pin for Figure 1-1 and 40-pin for Figure 1-2. The 28-pin and 40-pin pinouts are listed in Table 1-1 and Table 1-2, respectively.
FIGURE 1-1:
Device PIC16F873 PIC16F876
Program Bus
Power-up Timer Instruction Decode & Control Timing Generation OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT Oscillator Start-up Timer Power-on Reset Watchdog Timer Brown-out Reset In-Circuit Debugger Low-Voltage Programming 8
MUX
ALU
W reg
MCLR
VDD, VSS
Timer0
Timer1
Timer2
10-bit A/D
Data EEPROM
CCP1,2
USART
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 5
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 1-2:
Device PIC16F874 PIC16F877
Program Bus
Power-up Timer Instruction Decode & Control Timing Generation OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT Oscillator Start-up Timer Power-on Reset Watchdog Timer Brown-out Reset In-Circuit Debugger Low-Voltage Programming 8
MUX
ALU
MCLR
VDD, VSS
RE2/AN7/CS
Timer0
Timer1
Timer2
10-bit A/D
Data EEPROM
CCP1,2
USART
DS30292A-page 6
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 1-1
Pin Name OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT
MCLR/VPP/THV
I/P
2 3 4 5 6 7
2 3 4 5 6 7
ST/CMOS(3) Oscillator crystal input/external clock source input. Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in crystal oscillator mode. In RC mode, the OSC2 pin outputs CLKOUT which has 1/4 the frequency of OSC1, and denotes the instruction cycle rate. ST Master clear (reset) input or programming voltage input or high voltage test mode control. This pin is an active low reset to the device. PORTA is a bi-directional I/O port. TTL RA0 can also be analog input0 TTL TTL TTL ST TTL RA1 can also be analog input1 RA2 can also be analog input2 or negative analog reference voltage RA3 can also be analog input3 or positive analog reference voltage RA4 can also be the clock input to the Timer0 module. Output is open drain type. RA5 can also be analog input4 or the slave select for the synchronous serial port. PORTB is a bi-directional I/O port. PORTB can be software programmed for internal weak pull-up on all inputs. RB0 can also be the external interrupt pin.
RB3 can also be the low voltage programming input Interrupt on change pin. Interrupt on change pin. Interrupt on change pin or In-Circuit Debugger pin. Serial programming clock. RB7/PGD 28 28 I/O TTL/ST(2) Interrupt on change pin or In-Circuit Debugger pin. Serial programming data. PORTC is a bi-directional I/O port. RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI 11 11 I/O ST RC0 can also be the Timer1 oscillator output or Timer1 clock input. RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 12 12 I/O ST RC1 can also be the Timer1 oscillator input or Capture2 input/Compare2 output/PWM2 output. RC2/CCP1 13 13 I/O ST RC2 can also be the Capture1 input/Compare1 output/ PWM1 output. RC3/SCK/SCL 14 14 I/O ST RC3 can also be the synchronous serial clock input/output for both SPI and I2C modes. RC4/SDI/SDA 15 15 I/O ST RC4 can also be the SPI Data In (SPI mode) or data I/O (I2C mode). RC5/SDO 16 16 I/O ST RC5 can also be the SPI Data Out (SPI mode). RC6/TX/CK 17 17 I/O ST RC6 can also be the USART Asynchronous Transmit or Synchronous Clock. RC7/RX/DT 18 18 I/O ST RC7 can also be the USART Asynchronous Receive or Synchronous Data. VSS 8, 19 8, 19 P Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. VDD 20 20 P Positive supply for logic and I/O pins. Legend: I = input O = output I/O = input/output P = power = Not used TTL = TTL input ST = Schmitt Trigger input Note 1: This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured as the external interrupt. 2: This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when used in serial programming mode. 3: This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured in RC oscillator mode and a CMOS input otherwise.
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 7
PIC16F87X
TABLE 1-2
Pin Name OSC1/CLKIN OSC2/CLKOUT
ST/CMOS(4) Oscillator crystal input/external clock source input. Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in crystal oscillator mode. In RC mode, OSC2 pin outputs CLKOUT which has 1/4 the frequency of OSC1, and denotes the instruction cycle rate. Master clear (reset) input or programming voltage input or high voltage test mode control. This pin is an active low reset to the device. PORTA is a bi-directional I/O port.
MCLR/VPP/THV
18
I/P
ST
2 3 4 5 6 7
3 4 5 6 7 8
19 20 21 22 23 24
RA0 can also be analog input0 RA1 can also be analog input1 RA2 can also be analog input2 or negative analog reference voltage RA3 can also be analog input3 or positive analog reference voltage RA4 can also be the clock input to the Timer0 timer/ counter. Output is open drain type. RA5 can also be analog input4 or the slave select for the synchronous serial port. PORTB is a bi-directional I/O port. PORTB can be software programmed for internal weak pull-up on all inputs.
RB0/INT RB1 RB2 RB3/PGM RB4 RB5 RB6/PGC RB7/PGD Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4:
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
36 37 38 39 41 42 43 44
8 9 10 11 14 15 16 17
RB3 can also be the low voltage programming input Interrupt on change pin. Interrupt on change pin. Interrupt on change pin or In-Circuit Debugger pin. Serial programming clock.
Interrupt on change pin or In-Circuit Debugger pin. Serial programming data. I = input O = output I/O = input/output P = power = Not used TTL = TTL input ST = Schmitt Trigger input This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured as an external interrupt. This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when used in serial programming mode. This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured as general purpose I/O and a TTL input when used in the Parallel Slave Port mode (for interfacing to a microprocessor bus). This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured in RC oscillator mode and a CMOS input otherwise.
TTL/ST(2)
DS30292A-page 8
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 1-2
Pin Name
15 16 17 18 23 24 25 26
16 18 19 20 25 26 27 29
32 35 36 37 42 43 44 1
ST ST ST ST ST ST ST ST
RC0 can also be the Timer1 oscillator output or a Timer1 clock input. RC1 can also be the Timer1 oscillator input or Capture2 input/Compare2 output/PWM2 output. RC2 can also be the Capture1 input/Compare1 output/ PWM1 output. RC3 can also be the synchronous serial clock input/ output for both SPI and I2C modes. RC4 can also be the SPI Data In (SPI mode) or data I/O (I2C mode). RC5 can also be the SPI Data Out (SPI mode). RC6 can also be the USART Asynchronous Transmit or Synchronous Clock. RC7 can also be the USART Asynchronous Receive or Synchronous Data. PORTD is a bi-directional I/O port or parallel slave port when interfacing to a microprocessor bus.
19 20 21 22 27 28 29 30 8 9 10 12,31 11,32
I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O P P
ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) PORTE is a bi-directional I/O port. ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) ST/TTL(3) RE0 can also be read control for the parallel slave port, or analog input5. RE1 can also be write control for the parallel slave port, or analog input6. RE2 can also be select control for the parallel slave port, or analog input7. Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Positive supply for logic and I/O pins. These pins are not internally connected. These pins should be left unconnected.
O = output I/O = input/output P = power = Not used TTL = TTL input ST = Schmitt Trigger input This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured as an external interrupt. This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when used in serial programming mode. This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured as general purpose I/O and a TTL input when used in the Parallel Slave Port mode (for interfacing to a microprocessor bus). This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured in RC oscillator mode and a CMOS input otherwise.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 9
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 10
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.0 MEMORY ORGANIZATION
FIGURE 2-2:
There are three memory blocks in each of these PICmicros. The Program Memory and Data Memory have separate buses so that concurrent access can occur and is detailed in this section. The EEPROM data memory block is detailed in Section 4.0. Additional information on device memory may be found in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
13
2.1
The PIC16F87X PICmicros have a 13-bit program counter capable of addressing an 8K x 14 program memory space. The PIC16F877/876 devices have 8K x 14 words of FLASH program memory and the PIC16F873/874 devices have 4K x 14. Accessing a location above the physically implemented address will cause a wraparound. The reset vector is at 0000h and the interrupt vector is at 0004h.
Reset Vector
0000h
Interrupt Vector
0004h 0005h
FIGURE 2-1:
13
1FFFh
Stack Level 8
Reset Vector
0000h
Interrupt Vector
0004h 0005h
Page 0 07FFh 0800h On-chip Program Memory Page 1 0FFFh 1000h Page 2 17FFh 1800h Page 3 1FFFh
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 11
PIC16F87X
2.2 Data Memory Organization
The data memory is partitioned into multiple banks which contain the General Purpose Registers and the Special Function Registers. Bits RP1 and RP0 are the bank select bits. RP1 = 00 = 01 = 10 = 11 RP0 Bank0 Bank1 Bank2 Bank3 (STATUS<6:5>)
Each bank extends up to 7Fh (128 bytes). The lower locations of each bank are reserved for the Special Function Registers. Above the Special Function Registers are General Purpose Registers, implemented as static RAM. All implemented banks contain special function registers. Some high use special function registers from one bank may be mirrored in another bank for code reduction and quicker access. Note: EEPROM Data Memory description can be found in Section 7.0 of this Data Sheet GENERAL PURPOSE REGISTER FILE
2.2.1
The register le can be accessed either directly, or indirectly through the File Select Register FSR.
DS30292A-page 12
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 2-3: PIC16F877/876 REGISTER FILE MAP
File Address Indirect addr.(*) TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR PORTA PORTB PORTC PORTD (1) PORTE (1) PCLATH INTCON PIR1 PIR2 TMR1L TMR1H T1CON TMR2 T2CON SSPBUF SSPCON CCPR1L CCPR1H CCP1CON RCSTA TXREG RCREG CCPR2L CCPR2H CCP2CON ADRESH ADCON0 00h 01h 02h 03h 04h 05h 06h 07h 08h 09h 0Ah 0Bh 0Ch 0Dh 0Eh 0Fh 10h 11h 12h 13h 14h 15h 16h 17h 18h 19h 1Ah 1Bh 1Ch 1Dh 1Eh 1Fh 20h Indirect addr.(*) 80h OPTION_REG 81h 82h PCL 83h STATUS 84h FSR 85h TRISA 86h TRISB 87h TRISC TRISD (1) 88h TRISE (1) 89h 8Ah PCLATH 8Bh INTCON 8Ch PIE1 8Dh PIE2 8Eh PCON 8Fh 90h 91h SSPCON2 92h PR2 93h SSPADD 94h SSPSTAT 95h 96h 97h 98h TXSTA 99h SPBRG 9Ah 9Bh 9Ch 9Dh ADRESL 9Eh 9Fh ADCON1 A0h General Purpose Register 80 Bytes accesses 70h-7Fh 7Fh Bank 0 Bank 1 Indirect addr.(*) 100h 101h TMR0 102h PCL 103h STATUS 104h FSR 105h 106h PORTB 107h 108h 109h 10Ah PCLATH 10Bh INTCON 10Ch EEDATA 10Dh EEADR 10Eh EEDATH 10Fh EEADRH 110h 111h 112h 113h 114h 115h 116h General 117h Purpose 118h Register 119h 16 Bytes 11Ah 11Bh 11Ch 11Dh 11Eh 11Fh 120h Indirect addr.(*) OPTION_REG PCL STATUS FSR TRISB 180h 181h 182h 183h 184h 185h 186h 187h 188h 189h 18Ah 18Bh 18Ch 18Dh 18Eh 18Fh 190h 191h 192h 193h 194h 195h 196h 197h 198h 199h 19Ah 19Bh 19Ch 19Dh 19Eh 19Fh 1A0h
Unimplemented data memory locations, read as '0'. * Not a physical register. Note 1: These registers are not implemented on 28-pin devices. 2: These registers are reserved, maintain these registers clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 13
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 2-4: PIC16F874/873 REGISTER FILE MAP
File Address Indirect addr.(*) TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR PORTA PORTB PORTC PORTD (1) PORTE (1) PCLATH INTCON PIR1 PIR2 TMR1L TMR1H T1CON TMR2 T2CON SSPBUF SSPCON CCPR1L CCPR1H CCP1CON RCSTA TXREG RCREG CCPR2L CCPR2H CCP2CON ADRESH ADCON0 00h 01h 02h 03h 04h 05h 06h 07h 08h 09h 0Ah 0Bh 0Ch 0Dh 0Eh 0Fh 10h 11h 12h 13h 14h 15h 16h 17h 18h 19h 1Ah 1Bh 1Ch 1Dh 1Eh 1Fh 20h Indirect addr.(*) 80h OPTION_REG 81h 82h PCL 83h STATUS 84h FSR 85h TRISA 86h TRISB 87h TRISC TRISD (1) 88h TRISE (1) 89h 8Ah PCLATH 8Bh INTCON 8Ch PIE1 PIE2 8Dh 8Eh PCON 8Fh 90h SSPCON2 91h 92h PR2 93h SSPADD 94h SSPSTAT 95h 96h 97h 98h TXSTA 99h SPBRG 9Ah 9Bh 9Ch 9Dh ADRESL 9Eh 9Fh ADCON1 A0h General Purpose Register 96 Bytes Indirect addr.(*) 100h 101h TMR0 102h PCL 103h STATUS 104h FSR 105h 106h PORTB 107h 108h 109h 10Ah PCLATH 10Bh INTCON 10Ch EEDATA EEADR 10Dh 10Eh EEDATH 10Fh EEADRH 110h Indirect addr.(*) OPTION_REG PCL STATUS FSR TRISB 180h 181h 182h 183h 184h 185h 186h 187h 188h 189h 18Ah 18Bh 18Ch 18Dh 18Eh 18Fh 190h
120h
1A0h
Unimplemented data memory locations, read as '0'. * Not a physical register. Note 1: These registers are not implemented on 28-pin devices.
2: These registers are reserved, maintain these registers clear.
DS30292A-page 14
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.2.2 SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS The Special Function Registers are registers used by the CPU and Peripheral Modules for controlling the desired operation of the device. These registers are implemented as static RAM. A list of these registers is give in Table 2-1. The special function registers can be classied into two sets; core (CPU) and peripheral. Those registers associated with the core functions are described in detail in this section. Those related to the operation of the peripheral features are described in detail in that peripheral feature section.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 15
PIC16F87X
TABLE 2-1:
Address Name
INDF TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR PORTA PORTB PORTC PORTD PORTE PCLATH INTCON PIR1 PIR2 TMR1L TMR1H T1CON TMR2 T2CON SSPBUF SSPCON CCPR1L CCPR1H CCP1CON RCSTA TXREG RCREG CCPR2L CCPR2H CCP2CON ADRESH ADCON0
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) Timer0 modules register Program Counter's (PC) Least Signicant Byte IRP RP1 RP0 TO PD Z DC C
0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 1xxx 000q quuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu --0x 0000 --0u 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
04h(4) 05h 06h 07h 08h(5) 09h(5) 0Ah(1,4) 0Bh(4) 0Ch 0Dh 0Eh 0Fh 10h 11h 12h 13h 14h 15h 16h 17h 18h 19h 1Ah 1Bh 1Ch 1Dh 1Eh 1Fh
Indirect data memory address pointer PORTA Data Latch when written: PORTA pins when read
PORTB Data Latch when written: PORTB pins when read PORTC Data Latch when written: PORTC pins when read PORTD Data Latch when written: PORTD pins when read GIE PSPIF(3) PEIE ADIF (6) T0IE RCIF RE2 RE1 RE0
---- -xxx ---- -uuu ---0 0000 ---0 0000 0000 000x 0000 000u 0000 0000 0000 0000 -r-0 0--0 -r-0 0--0 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the Program Counter INTE TXIF EEIF RBIE SSPIF BCLIF T0IF CCP1IF INTF TMR2IF RBIF TMR1IF CCP2IF
Holding register for the Least Signicant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register Holding register for the Most Signicant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC
TMR1CS TMR1ON --00 0000 --uu uuuu 0000 0000 0000 0000
TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 -000 0000 -000 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu SSPM2 SSPM1 SSPM0 0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu CCP1M3 ADDEN CCP1M2 FERR CCP1M1 OERR CCP1M0 --00 0000 --00 0000 RX9D 0000 000x 0000 000x 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu CCP2M3 CCP2M2 CCP2M1 CCP2M0 --00 0000 --00 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register WCOL SSPOV SSPEN CKP SSPM3
Capture/Compare/PWM Register1 (LSB) Capture/Compare/PWM Register1 (MSB) SPEN RX9 CCP1X SREN CCP1Y CREN
USART Transmit Data Register USART Receive Data Register Capture/Compare/PWM Register2 (LSB) Capture/Compare/PWM Register2 (MSB) CCP2X CCP2Y
A/D Result Register High Byte ADCS1 ADCS0 CHS2 CHS1 CHS0 GO/ DONE ADON
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, q = value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0', r = reserved. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as 0.
Note 1: The upper byte of the program counter is not directly accessible. PCLATH is a holding register for the PC<12:8> whose contents are transferred to the upper byte of the program counter.
2: 3: 4: 5: 6: Other (non power-up) resets include external reset through MCLR and Watchdog Timer Reset. Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear. These registers can be addressed from any bank. PORTD, PORTE, TRISD, and TRISE are not physically implemented on the 28-pin devices, read as 0. PIR2<6> and PIE2<6> are reserved on these devices, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30292A-page 16
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 2-1:
Address Name
INDF OPTION_RE G PCL STATUS FSR TRISA TRISB TRISC TRISD TRISE PCLATH INTCON PIE1 PIE2 PCON SSPCON2 PR2 SSPADD SSPSTAT TXSTA SPBRG ADRESL ADCON1
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) RBPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0
0000 0000 0000 0000 1111 1111 1111 1111 0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu --11 1111 --11 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111
84h(4) 85h 86h 87h 88h(5) 89h(5) 8Ah(1,4) 8Bh(4) 8Ch 8Dh 8Eh 8Fh 90h 91h 92h 93h 94h 95h 96h 97h 98h 99h 9Ah 9Bh 9Ch 9Dh 9Eh 9Fh
PORTB Data Direction Register PORTC Data Direction Register PORTD Data Direction Register IBF GIE PSPIE(3) Unimplemented Unimplemented GCEN ACKSTAT ACKDT ACKEN RCEN PEN RSEN SEN OBF PEIE ADIE (6) IBOV T0IE RCIE PSPMODE PORTE Data Direction Bits
0000 -111 0000 -111 ---0 0000 ---0 0000 0000 000x 0000 000u 0000 0000 0000 0000 -r-0 0--0 -r-0 0--0 ---- --qq ---- --uu
Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the Program Counter INTE TXIE EEIE RBIE SSPIE BCLIE T0IF CCP1IE INTF TMR2IE POR RBIF TMR1IE CCP2IE BOR
Timer2 Period Register Synchronous Serial Port (I C mode) Address Register SMP CKE D/A P S R/W UA BF
2
Unimplemented Unimplemented Unimplemented CSRC TX9 TXEN SYNC BRGH TRMT TX9D
Baud Rate Generator Register Unimplemented Unimplemented Unimplemented Unimplemented A/D Result Register Low Byte ADFM PCFG3 PCFG2 PCFG1 PCFG0
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, q = value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0', r = reserved. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as 0.
Note 1: The upper byte of the program counter is not directly accessible. PCLATH is a holding register for the PC<12:8> whose contents are transferred to the upper byte of the program counter.
2: 3: 4: 5: 6: Other (non power-up) resets include external reset through MCLR and Watchdog Timer Reset. Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear. These registers can be addressed from any bank. PORTD, PORTE, TRISD, and TRISE are not physically implemented on the 28-pin devices, read as 0. PIR2<6> and PIE2<6> are reserved on these devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 17
PIC16F87X
TABLE 2-1:
Address Name
Bank 2 100h(4) 101h 102h(4) 103h(4) 104h(4) 105h 106h 107h 108h 109h 10Ah
(1,4)
INDF TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR PORTB PCLATH INTCON EEDATA EEADR EEDATH EEADRH
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) Timer0 modules register Program Counter's (PC) Least Signicant Byte IRP RP1 RP0 TO PD Z DC C
0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 1xxx 000q quuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
Indirect data memory address pointer Unimplemented PORTB Data Latch when written: PORTB pins when read Unimplemented Unimplemented Unimplemented GIE PEIE T0IE Write Buffer for the upper 5 bits of the Program Counter INTE RBIE T0IF INTF RBIF
---0 0000 ---0 0000 0000 000x 0000 000u xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
EEPROM data register EEPROM address register EEPROM data register high byte EEPROM address register high byte Bank 3
180h(4) 181h 182h(4) 183h(4) 184h(4) 185h 186h 187h 188h 189h 18Ah(1,4) 18Bh(4) 18Ch 18Dh 18Eh 18Fh
INDF OPTION_RE G PCL STATUS FSR TRISB PCLATH INTCON EECON1 EECON2
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) RBPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0
0000 0000 0000 0000 1111 1111 1111 1111 0000 0000 0000 0000
Indirect data memory address pointer Unimplemented PORTB Data Direction Register Unimplemented Unimplemented Unimplemented GIE EEPGD PEIE T0IE
---0 0000 ---0 0000 0000 000x 0000 000u x--- x000 x--- u000 ---- ---- ---- ---0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
EEPROM control register2 (not a physical register) Reserved maintain clear Reserved maintain clear
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, q = value depends on condition, - = unimplemented read as '0', r = reserved. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as 0.
Note 1: The upper byte of the program counter is not directly accessible. PCLATH is a holding register for the PC<12:8> whose contents are transferred to the upper byte of the program counter.
2: 3: 4: 5: 6: Other (non power-up) resets include external reset through MCLR and Watchdog Timer Reset. Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear. These registers can be addressed from any bank. PORTD, PORTE, TRISD, and TRISE are not physically implemented on the 28-pin devices, read as 0. PIR2<6> and PIE2<6> are reserved on these devices, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30292A-page 18
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.1 STATUS REGISTER The STATUS register, shown in Figure 2-5, contains the arithmetic status of the ALU, the RESET status and the bank select bits for data memory. The STATUS register can be the destination for any instruction, as with any other register. If the STATUS register is the destination for an instruction that affects the Z, DC or C bits, then the write to these three bits is disabled. These bits are set or cleared according to the device logic. Furthermore, the TO and PD bits are not writable. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the STATUS register as destination may be different than intended. For example, CLRF STATUS will clear the upper-three bits and set the Z bit. This leaves the STATUS register as 000u u1uu (where u = unchanged). It is recommended, therefore, that only BCF, BSF, SWAPF and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the STATUS register because these instructions do not affect the Z, C or DC bits from the STATUS register. For other instructions, not affecting any status bits, see the "Instruction Set Summary." Note 1: The C and DC bits operate as a borrow and digit borrow bit, respectively, in subtraction. See the SUBLW and SUBWF instructions for examples.
FIGURE 2-5:
R/W-0 IRP bit7
R/W-0 RP1
R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
IRP: Register Bank Select bit (used for indirect addressing) 1 = Bank 2, 3 (100h - 1FFh) 0 = Bank 0, 1 (00h - FFh)
bit 6-5: RP1:RP0: Register Bank Select bits (used for direct addressing) 11 = Bank 3 (180h - 1FFh) 10 = Bank 2 (100h - 17Fh) 01 = Bank 1 (80h - FFh) 00 = Bank 0 (00h - 7Fh) Each bank is 128 bytes bit 4: TO: Time-out bit 1 = After power-up, CLRWDT instruction, or SLEEP instruction 0 = A WDT time-out occurred PD: Power-down bit 1 = After power-up or by the CLRWDT instruction 0 = By execution of the SLEEP instruction Z: Zero bit 1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero 0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero DC: Digit carry/borrow bit (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWF instructions) (for borrow the polarity is reversed) 1 = A carry-out from the 4th low order bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the 4th low order bit of the result C: Carry/borrow bit (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWF instructions) 1 = A carry-out from the most signicant bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the most signicant bit of the result occurred Note: For borrow the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the twos complement of the second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high or low order bit of the source register.
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 19
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.2 OPTION_REG REGISTER Note: To achieve a 1:1 prescaler assignment for the TMR0 register, assign the prescaler to the Watchdog Timer. The OPTION_REG register is a readable and writable register which contains various control bits to congure the TMR0 prescaler/WDT postscaler (single assignable register known also as the prescaler), the External INT Interrupt, TMR0, and the weak pull-ups on PORTB.
FIGURE 2-6:
R/W-1 RBPU bit7
R/W-1 INTEDG
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7:
RBPU: PORTB Pull-up Enable bit 1 = PORTB pull-ups are disabled 0 = PORTB pull-ups are enabled by individual port latch values INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit 1 = Interrupt on rising edge of RB0/INT pin 0 = Interrupt on falling edge of RB0/INT pin T0CS: TMR0 Clock Source Select bit 1 = Transition on RA4/T0CKI pin 0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (CLKOUT) T0SE: TMR0 Source Edge Select bit 1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on RA4/T0CKI pin 0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on RA4/T0CKI pin PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit 1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT 0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
DS30292A-page 20
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.3 INTCON REGISTER Note: Interrupt ag bits get set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the global enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt ag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. The INTCON Register is a readable and writable register which contains various enable and ag bits for the TMR0 register overow, RB Port change and External RB0/INT pin interrupts.
FIGURE 2-7:
R/W-0 GIE bit7
R/W-0 PEIE
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7:
GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables all un-masked interrupts 0 = Disables all interrupts PEIE: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables all un-masked peripheral interrupts 0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts T0IE: TMR0 Overow Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the TMR0 interrupt 0 = Disables the TMR0 interrupt INTE: RB0/INT External Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the RB0/INT external interrupt 0 = Disables the RB0/INT external interrupt RBIE: RB Port Change Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the RB port change interrupt 0 = Disables the RB port change interrupt T0IF: TMR0 Overow Interrupt Flag bit 1 = TMR0 register has overowed (must be cleared in software) 0 = TMR0 register did not overow INTF: RB0/INT External Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The RB0/INT external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = The RB0/INT external interrupt did not occur RBIF: RB Port Change Interrupt Flag bit 1 = At least one of the RB7:RB4 pins changed state (must be cleared in software) 0 = None of the RB7:RB4 pins have changed state
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 21
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.4 PIE1 REGISTER Note: Bit PEIE (INTCON<6>) must be set to enable any peripheral interrupt. This register contains the individual enable bits for the peripheral interrupts.
FIGURE 2-8:
R/W-0 PSPIE bit7
(1)
R/W-0 ADIE
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7:
PSPIE(1): Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the PSP read/write interrupt 0 = Disables the PSP read/write interrupt ADIE: A/D Converter Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the A/D converter interrupt 0 = Disables the A/D converter interrupt RCIE: USART Receive Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the USART receive interrupt 0 = Disables the USART receive interrupt TXIE: USART Transmit Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the USART transmit interrupt 0 = Disables the USART transmit interrupt SSPIE: Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the SSP interrupt 0 = Disables the SSP interrupt CCP1IE: CCP1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the CCP1 interrupt 0 = Disables the CCP1 interrupt TMR2IE: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt 0 = Disables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt TMR1IE: TMR1 Overow Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the TMR1 overow interrupt 0 = Disables the TMR1 overow interrupt
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
Note 1: PSPIE is reserved on 28-pin devices, always maintain this bit clear.
DS30292A-page 22
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.5 PIR1 REGISTER Note: This register contains the individual ag bits for the Peripheral interrupts. Interrupt ag bits get set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the global enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>).
FIGURE 2-9:
R/W-0 PSPIF(1) bit7
R/W-0 ADIF
bit 7:
PSPIF(1): Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Flag bit 1 = A read or a write operation has taken place (must be cleared in software) 0 = No read or write has occurred ADIF: A/D Converter Interrupt Flag bit 1 = An A/D conversion completed 0 = The A/D conversion is not complete RCIF: USART Receive Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The USART receive buffer is full 0 = The USART receive buffer is empty TXIF: USART Transmit Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The USART transmit buffer is empty 0 = The USART transmit buffer is full SSPIF: Synchronous Serial Port (SSP) Interrupt Flag 1 = The SSP interrupt condition has occurred, and must be cleared in software before returning from the interrupt service routine. The conditions that will set this bit are: SPI A transmission/reception has taken place. I2C Slave A transmission/reception has taken place. I2C Master A transmission/reception has taken place. The initiated start condition was completed by the SSP module. The initiated stop condition was completed by the SSP module. The initiated restart condition was completed by the SSP module. The initiated acknowledge condition was completed by the SSP module. A start condition occurred while the SSP module was idle (Multimaster system). A stop condition occurred while the SSP module was idle (Multimaster system). 0 = No SSP interrupt condition has occurred. CCP1IF: CCP1 Interrupt Flag bit Capture Mode 1 = A TMR1 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register capture occurred Compare Mode 1 = A TMR1 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register compare match occurred PWM Mode Unused in this mode TMR2IF: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit 1 = TMR2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR2 to PR2 match occurred
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 7:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
TMR1IF: TMR1 Overow Interrupt Flag bit 1 = TMR1 register overowed (must be cleared in software) 0 = TMR1 register did not overow Note 1: PSPIF is reserved on 28-pin devices, always maintain this bit clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 23
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.6 PIE2 REGISTER This register contains the individual enable bits for the CCP2 peripheral interrupt, the SSP bus collision interrupt, and the EEPROM write operation interrupt.
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
Unimplemented: Read as '0' Reserved: Always maintain this bit clear Unimplemented: Read as '0' EEIE: EEPROM Write Operation Interrupt Enable 1 = Enable EE Write Interrupt 0 = Disable EE Write Interrupt BCLIE: Bus Collision Interrupt Enable 1 = Enable Bus Collision Interrupt 0 = Disable Bus Collision Interrupt CCP2IE: CCP2 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the CCP2 interrupt 0 = Disables the CCP2 interrupt
bit 3:
DS30292A-page 24
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.7 PIR2 REGISTER
.
This register contains the ag bits for the CCP2 interrupt, the SSP bus collision interrupt and the EEPROM write operation interrupt.
Note:
Interrupt ag bits get set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the global enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt ag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt.
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
Unimplemented: Read as '0' Reserved: Always maintain this bit clear Unimplemented: Read as '0' EEIF: EEPROM Write Operation Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The write operation completed (must be cleared in software) 0 = The write operation is not complete or has not been started BCLIF: Bus Collision Interrupt Flag 1 = A bus collision has occurred in the SSP, when congured for I2C master mode 0 = No bus collision has occurred CCP2IF: CCP2 Interrupt Flag bit Capture Mode 1 = A TMR1 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register capture occurred Compare Mode 1 = A TMR1 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register compare match occurred PWM Mode Unused
bit 3:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 25
PIC16F87X
2.2.2.8 PCON REGISTER Note: The Power Control (PCON) register contains a ag bit to allow differentiation between a Power-on Reset (POR) to an external MCLR Reset or WDT Reset. Those devices with brown-out detection circuitry contain an additional bit to differentiate a Brown-out Reset condition from a Power-on Reset condition. BOR is unknown on Power-on Reset if the BOR circuit is disabled by clearing the BODEN bit in Conguration Word. The BOR status bit is a don't care and is not necessarily predictable if the brown-out circuit is disabled.
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7-2: Unimplemented: Read as '0' bit 1: POR: Power-on Reset Status bit 1 = No Power-on Reset occurred 0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs) BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit 1 = No Brown-out Reset occurred 0 = A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Brown-out Reset occurs)
bit 0:
DS30292A-page 26
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
2.3 PCL and PCLATH 2.4 Program Memory Paging
The program counter (PC) species the address of the instruction to fetch for execution. The PC is 13 bits wide. The low byte is called the PCL register. This register is readable and writable. The high byte is called the PCH register. This register contains the PC<12:8> bits and is not directly readable or writable. All updates to the PCH register go through the PCLATH register. 2.3.1 STACK PIC16F87X devices are capable of addressing a continuous 8K word block of program memory. The CALL and GOTO instructions provide only 11 bits of address to allow branching within any 2K program memory page. When doing a CALL or GOTO instruction the upper 2 bits of the address are provided by PCLATH<4:3>. When doing a CALL or GOTO instruction, the user must ensure that the page select bits are programmed so that the desired program memory page is addressed. If a return from a CALL instruction (or interrupt) is executed, the entire 13-bit PC is pushed onto the stack. Therefore, manipulation of the PCLATH<4:3> bits are not required for the return instructions (which POPs the address from the stack). The INDF register is not a physical register. Addressing INDF actually addresses the register whose address is contained in the FSR register (FSR is a pointer). This is indirect addressing.
The stack allows a combination of up to 8 program calls and interrupts to occur. The stack contains the return address from this branch in program execution. Midrange devices have an 8 level deep x 13-bit wide hardware stack. The stack space is not part of either program or data space and the stack pointer is not readable or writable. The PC is PUSHed onto the stack when a CALL instruction is executed or an interrupt causes a branch. The stack is POPed in the event of a RETURN, RETLW or a RETFIE instruction execution. PCLATH is not modied when the stack is PUSHed or POPed. After the stack has been PUSHed eight times, the ninth push overwrites the value that was stored from the rst push. The tenth push overwrites the second push (and so on).
EXAMPLE 2-1:
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
Register le 05 contains the value 10h Register le 06 contains the value 0Ah Load the value 05 into the FSR register A read of the INDF register will return the value of 10h Increment the value of the FSR register by one (FSR = 06) A read of the INDF register now will return the value of 0Ah. Reading INDF itself indirectly (FSR = 0) will produce 00h. Writing to the INDF register indirectly results in a no-operation (although STATUS bits may be affected). A simple program to clear RAM locations 20h-2Fh using indirect addressing is shown in Example 2-2.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 27
PIC16F87X
EXAMPLE 2-2: HOW TO CLEAR RAM USING INDIRECT ADDRESSING
0x20 FSR INDF FSR FSR,4 NEXT ;initialize pointer ; to RAM ;clear INDF register ;inc pointer ;all done? ;NO, clear next ;YES, continue
NEXT
CONTINUE
An effective 9-bit address is obtained by concatenating the 8-bit FSR register and the IRP bit (STATUS<7>), as shown in Figure 2-13.
bank select
bank select
location select
Data Memory(1)
7Fh Bank 0
FFh Bank 1
17Fh Bank 2
1FFh Bank 3
DS30292A-page 28
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
3.0 I/O PORTS
FIGURE 3-1:
Data bus WR Port
Some pins for these I/O ports are multiplexed with an alternate function for the peripheral features on the device. In general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may not be used as a general purpose I/O pin. Additional information on I/O ports may be found in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
CK
Data Latch
3.1
I/O pin(1)
PORTA is a 6-bit wide bi-directional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISA. Setting a TRISA bit (=1) will make the corresponding PORTA pin an input, i.e., put the corresponding output driver in a hi-impedance mode. Clearing a TRISA bit (=0) will make the corresponding PORTA pin an output, i.e., put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin. Reading the PORTA register reads the status of the pins whereas writing to it will write to the port latch. All write operations are read-modify-write operations. Therefore a write to a port implies that the port pins are read, this value is modied, and then written to the port data latch. Pin RA4 is multiplexed with the Timer0 module clock input to become the RA4/T0CKI pin. The RA4/T0CKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input and an open drain output. All other RA port pins have TTL input levels and full CMOS output drivers. Other PORTA pins are multiplexed with analog inputs and analog VREF input. The operation of each pin is selected by clearing/setting the control bits in the ADCON1 register (A/D Control Register1). Note: On a Power-on Reset, these pins are congured as analog inputs and read as '0'.
CK
TRIS Latch
RD TRIS Q D
EN RD PORT
To A/D Converter Note 1: I/O pins have protection diodes to VDD and VSS.
FIGURE 3-2:
Data bus WR PORT
The TRISA register controls the direction of the RA pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs. The user must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are maintained set when using them as analog inputs.
CK
I/O pin(1)
EXAMPLE 3-1:
BCF CLRF
INITIALIZING PORTA
; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Initialize PORTA by clearing output data latches Select Bank 1 Value used to initialize data direction Set RA<3:0> as inputs RA<5:4> as outputs TRISA<7:6> are always read as '0'.
WR TRIS
CK
TRIS Latch
BSF MOVLW
RD TRIS Q D EN EN RD PORT
MOVWF
TRISA
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 29
PIC16F87X
TABLE 3-1
Name RA0/AN0 RA1/AN1 RA2/AN2 RA3/AN3/VREF RA4/T0CKI
PORTA FUNCTIONS
Bit# bit0 bit1 bit2 bit3 bit4 Buffer TTL TTL TTL TTL ST Function
Input/output or analog input Input/output or analog input Input/output or analog input Input/output or analog input or VREF Input/output or external clock input for Timer0 Output is open drain type RA5/SS/AN4 bit5 TTL Input/output or slave select input for synchronous serial port or analog input Legend: TTL = TTL input, ST = Schmitt Trigger input
TABLE 3-2
Address Name 05h 85h 9Fh
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented locations read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA.
DS30292A-page 30
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
3.2 PORTB and the TRISB Register
PORTB is an 8-bit wide bi-directional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISB. Setting a TRISB bit (=1) will make the corresponding PORTB pin an input, i.e., put the corresponding output driver in a hi-impedance mode. Clearing a TRISB bit (=0) will make the corresponding PORTB pin an output, i.e., put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin. Three pins of PORTB are multiplexed with the Low Voltage Programming function; RB3/PGM, RB6/PGC and RB7/PGD. The alternate functions of these pins are described in the Special Features Section. Four of PORTBs pins, RB7:RB4, have an interrupt on change feature. Only pins congured as inputs can cause this interrupt to occur (i.e. any RB7:RB4 pin congured as an output is excluded from the interrupt on change comparison). The input pins (of RB7:RB4) are compared with the old value latched on the last read of PORTB. The mismatch outputs of RB7:RB4 are ORed together to generate the RB Port Change Interrupt with ag bit RBIF (INTCON<0>). This interrupt can wake the device from SLEEP. The user, in the interrupt service routine, can clear the interrupt in the following manner: a) b) Any read or write of PORTB. This will end the mismatch condition. Clear ag bit RBIF.
EXAMPLE 3-1:
BCF CLRF
INITIALIZING PORTB
; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Initialize PORTB by clearing output data latches Select Bank 1 Value used to initialize data direction Set RB<3:0> as inputs RB<5:4> as outputs RB<7:6> as inputs
A mismatch condition will continue to set ag bit RBIF. Reading PORTB will end the mismatch condition, and allow ag bit RBIF to be cleared. The interrupt on change feature is recommended for wake-up on key depression operation and operations where PORTB is only used for the interrupt on change feature. Polling of PORTB is not recommended while using the interrupt on change feature.
BSF MOVLW
MOVWF
TRISB
Each of the PORTB pins has a weak internal pull-up. A single control bit can turn on all the pull-ups. This is performed by clearing bit RBPU (OPTION_REG<7>). The weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port pin is congured as an output. The pull-ups are disabled on a Power-on Reset.
FIGURE 3-4:
RBPU(2)
FIGURE 3-3:
RBPU(2)
WR TRIS
CK
ST Buffer
RD TRIS Q
Latch D EN Q1
WR TRIS
CK
RD TRIS Q RD Port D
D RD Port EN Q3
RB7:RB6 in serial programming mode EN Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS. 2: To enable weak pull-ups, set the appropriate TRIS bit(s) and clear the RBPU bit (OPTION_REG<7>). Schmitt Trigger Buffer RD Port
RB0/INT
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS. 2: To enable weak pull-ups, set the appropriate TRIS bit(s) and clear the RBPU bit (OPTION_REG<7>).
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 31
PIC16F87X
TABLE 3-3
Name RB0/INT
PORTB FUNCTIONS
Bit# bit0 Buffer TTL/ST(1) Function
Input/output pin or external interrupt input. Internal software programmable weak pull-up. RB1 bit1 TTL Input/output pin. Internal software programmable weak pull-up. RB2 bit2 TTL Input/output pin. Internal software programmable weak pull-up. RB3/PGM bit3 TTL Input/output pin or programming pin in LVP mode. Internal software programmable weak pull-up. RB4 bit4 TTL Input/output pin (with interrupt on change). Internal software programmable weak pull-up. RB5 bit5 TTL Input/output pin (with interrupt on change). Internal software programmable weak pull-up. RB6/PGC bit6 Input/output pin (with interrupt on change) or In-Circuit Debugger pin. InterTTL/ST(2) nal software programmable weak pull-up. Serial programming clock. RB7/PGD bit7 Input/output pin (with interrupt on change) or In-Circuit Debugger pin. InterTTL/ST(2) nal software programmable weak pull-up. Serial programming data. Legend: TTL = TTL input, ST = Schmitt Trigger input
Note 1: This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when congured as the external interrupt. 2: This buffer is a Schmitt Trigger input when used in serial programming mode.
TABLE 3-4
Address
06h, 106h 86h, 186h 81h, 181h
Bit 7
RB7
Bit 6
RB6
Bit 5
RB5
Bit 4
RB4
DS30292A-page 32
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
3.3 PORTC and the TRISC Register
PORTC is an 8-bit wide bi-directional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISC. Setting a TRISC bit (=1) will make the corresponding PORTC pin an input, i.e., put the corresponding output driver in a hi-impedance mode. Clearing a TRISC bit (=0) will make the corresponding PORTC pin an output, i.e., put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin. PORTC is multiplexed with several peripheral functions (Table 3-5). PORTC pins have Schmitt Trigger input buffers. When the I2C module is enabled, the PORTC (3:4) pins can be congured with normal I2C levels or with SMBUS levels by using the CKE bit (SSPSTAT <6>). When enabling peripheral functions, care should be taken in dening TRIS bits for each PORTC pin. Some peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a pin an output, while other peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a pin an input. Since the TRIS bit override is in effect while the peripheral is enabled, read-modifywrite instructions (BSF, BCF, XORWF) with TRISC as destination should be avoided. The user should refer to the corresponding peripheral section for the correct TRIS bit settings.
FIGURE 3-5: PORTC BLOCK DIAGRAM (PERIPHERAL OUTPUT OVERRIDE) RC<0:2> RC<5:7>
PORT/PERIPHERAL Select(2) Peripheral Data Out Data bus WR PORT 0 D CK Q 1 Q VDD P
Data Latch WR TRIS D CK Q Q N VSS RD TRIS Peripheral OE(3) RD PORT Peripheral input Q D EN Schmitt Trigger I/O pin(1)
TRIS Latch
EXAMPLE 3-1:
BCF CLRF
INITIALIZING PORTC
; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Select Bank 0 Initialize PORTC by clearing output data latches Select Bank 1 Value used to initialize data direction Set RC<3:0> as inputs RC<5:4> as outputs RC<7:6> as inputs
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS. 2: Port/Peripheral select signal selects between port data and peripheral output. 3: Peripheral OE (output enable) is only activated if peripheral select is active.
BSF MOVLW
MOVWF
TRISC
Data Latch WR TRIS D CK Q Q N VSS RD TRIS Peripheral OE(3) RD PORT SSPl input 1 CKE SSPSTAT<6> Q D EN 0 Schmitt Trigger with SMBus levels Schmitt Trigger I/O pin(1)
TRIS Latch
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS. 2: Port/Peripheral select signal selects between port data and peripheral output. 3: Peripheral OE (output enable) is only activated if peripheral select is active.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 33
PIC16F87X
TABLE 3-5
Name RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 RC2/CCP1 RC3/SCK/SCL RC4/SDI/SDA RC5/SDO RC6/TX/CK RC7/RX/DT
PORTC FUNCTIONS
Bit#
bit0 bit1 bit2 bit3 bit4 bit5 bit6 bit7
Buffer Type ST ST ST ST ST ST ST ST
Function Input/output port pin or Timer1 oscillator output/Timer1 clock input Input/output port pin or Timer1 oscillator input or Capture2 input/ Compare2 output/PWM2 output Input/output port pin or Capture1 input/Compare1 output/PWM1 output RC3 can also be the synchronous serial clock for both SPI and I2C modes. RC4 can also be the SPI Data In (SPI mode) or data I/O (I2C mode). Input/output port pin or Synchronous Serial Port data output Input/output port pin or USART Asynchronous Transmit or Synchronous Clock Input/output port pin or USART Asynchronous Receive or Synchronous Data
TABLE 3-6
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
07h 87h
PORTC TRISC
RC7
RC6
RC5
RC4
RC3
RC2
RC1
RC0
DS30292A-page 34
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
3.4 PORTD and TRISD Registers FIGURE 3-7:
Data bus WR PORT
This section is not applicable to the 28-pin devices. PORTD is an 8-bit port with Schmitt Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually congurable as an input or output. PORTD can be congured as an 8-bit wide microprocessor port (parallel slave port) by setting control bit PSPMODE (TRISE<4>). In this mode, the input buffers are TTL.
D
I/O pin(1)
CK
Data Latch
D Q
WR TRIS
CK
TRIS Latch
RD TRIS
Q D EN EN
RD PORT Note 1: I/O pins have protection diodes to VDD and VSS.
TABLE 3-7
Name RD0/PSP0 RD1/PSP1 RD2/PSP2 RD3/PSP3 RD4/PSP4 RD5/PSP5 RD6/PSP6 RD7/PSP7
PORTD FUNCTIONS
Bit#
bit0 bit1 bit2 bit3 bit4 bit5 bit6 bit7
Buffer Type
ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1) ST/TTL(1)
Function Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit0 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit1 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit2 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit3 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit4 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit5 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit6 Input/output port pin or parallel slave port bit7
TABLE 3-8
Address Name
08h 88h 89h
Bit 4
RD4
Bit 3
RD3
Bit 2
RD2
Bit 1
RD1
Bit 0
RD0
PORTD Data Direction Register IBF OBF IBOV PSPMODE PORTE Data Direction Bits
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by PORTD.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 35
PIC16F87X
3.5 PORTE and TRISE Register FIGURE 3-8:
Data bus WR PORT
This section is not applicable to the 28-pin devices. PORTE has three pins RE0/RD/AN5, RE1/WR/AN6 and RE2/CS/AN7, which are individually congurable as inputs or outputs. These pins have Schmitt Trigger input buffers. I/O PORTE becomes control inputs for the microprocessor port when bit PSPMODE (TRISE<4>) is set. In this mode, the user must make sure that the TRISE<2:0> bits are set (pins are congured as digital inputs). Ensure ADCON1 is congured for digital I/O. In this mode the input buffers are TTL. Figure 3-9 shows the TRISE register, which also controls the parallel slave port operation. PORTE pins are multiplexed with analog inputs. When selected as an analog input, these pins will read as '0's. TRISE controls the direction of the RE pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs. The user must make sure to keep the pins congured as inputs when using them as analog inputs. Note: On a Power-on Reset these pins are congured as analog inputs.
I/O pin(1)
CK
Data Latch
D Q
WR TRIS
CK
TRIS Latch
RD TRIS
Q D EN EN
RD PORT Note 1: I/O pins have protection diodes to VDD and VSS.
FIGURE 3-9:
R-0 IBF bit7 R-0 OBF
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7 :
IBF: Input Buffer Full Status bit 1 = A word has been received and is waiting to be read by the CPU 0 = No word has been received OBF: Output Buffer Full Status bit 1 = The output buffer still holds a previously written word 0 = The output buffer has been read IBOV: Input Buffer Overow Detect bit (in microprocessor mode) 1 = A write occurred when a previously input word has not been read (must be cleared in software) 0 = No overow occurred PSPMODE: Parallel Slave Port Mode Select bit 1 = Parallel slave port mode 0 = General purpose I/O mode Unimplemented: Read as '0'
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3: bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
DS30292A-page 36
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 3-9
Name RE0/RD/AN5
PORTE FUNCTIONS
Bit# bit0 Buffer Type ST/TTL(1) Function
Input/output port pin or read control input in parallel slave port mode or analog input: RD 1 = Not a read operation 0 = Read operation. Reads PORTD register (if chip selected) (1) RE1/WR/AN6 bit1 Input/output port pin or write control input in parallel slave port mode or ST/TTL analog input: WR 1 =Not a write operation 0 =Write operation. Writes PORTD register (if chip selected) (1) RE2/CS/AN7 bit2 Input/output port pin or chip select control input in parallel slave port ST/TTL mode or analog input: CS 1 = Device is not selected 0 = Device is selected Legend: ST = Schmitt Trigger input TTL = TTL input
Note 1: Input buffers are Schmitt Triggers when in I/O mode and TTL buffers when in Parallel Slave Port Mode.
TABLE 3-10
Addr Name
09h 89h 9Fh PORTE TRISE ADCON1
Bit 6 Bit 5
OBF IBOV
Bit 4
PSPMODE
Bit 3
PCFG3
Bit 2
RE2
Bit 1
RE1
Bit 0
RE0
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by PORTE.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 37
PIC16F87X
3.6 Parallel Slave Port
The Parallel Slave Port is not implemented on the 28pin devices. PORTD operates as an 8-bit wide Parallel Slave Port, or microprocessor port when control bit PSPMODE (TRISE<4>) is set. In slave mode it is asynchronously readable and writable by the external world through RD control input pin RE0/RD and WR control input pin RE1/WR. It can directly interface to an 8-bit microprocessor data bus. The external microprocessor can read or write the PORTD latch as an 8-bit latch. Setting bit PSPMODE enables port pin RE0/RD to be the RD input, RE1/WR to be the WR input and RE2/CS to be the CS (chip select) input. For this functionality, the corresponding data direction bits of the TRISE register (TRISE<2:0>) must be congured as inputs (set). And the A/D port conguration bits PCFG3:PCFG0 (ADCON1<3:0>) must be set to congure pins RE2:RE0 as digital I/O. A write to the PSP occurs when both the CS and WR lines are rst detected low. A read from the PSP occurs when both the CS and RD lines are rst detected low.
FIGURE 3-10: PORTD AND PORTE BLOCK DIAGRAM (PARALLEL SLAVE PORT)
Data bus
D Q
WR PORT
CK
D EN EN
Read
TTL
RD CS WR
Chip Select
TTL
Write
TTL
DS30292A-page 38
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 3-12: PARALLEL SLAVE PORT READ WAVEFORMS
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
TABLE 3-11
Address Name
Bit 7
Bit 6 Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Port data latch when written: Port pins when read IBOV RCIF RCIE PSPMODE TXIF TXIE SSPIF SSPIE PCFG3 RE2 RE1
OBF
PORTE Data Direction Bits CCP1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF CCP1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE PCFG2 PCFG1 PCFG0
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the Parallel Slave Port.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 39
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 40
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
4.0 DATA EEPROM AND FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
4.1 EEADR
The address registers can address up to a maximum of 256 bytes of data EEPROM or up to a maximum of 8K words of program FLASH. When selecting a program address value, the MSByte of the address is written to the EEADRH register and the LSByte is written to the EEADR register. When selecting a data address value, only the LSByte of the address is written to the EEADR register. On the PIC16F874/873 devices with 128 bytes of EEPROM, the MSbit of the EEADR must always be cleared to prevent inadvertent access to the wrong location. This also applies to the program memory. The upper MSbits of EEADRH must always be clear.
The Data EEPROM and FLASH Program memory are readable and writable during normal operation over the entire VDD range. The data memory is not directly mapped in the register le space. Instead it is indirectly addressed through the Special Function Registers. There are six SFRs used to read and write the program and data EEPROM memory. These registers are: EECON1 EECON2 EEDATA EEDATH EEADR EEADRH
The EEPROM data memory allows byte read and write. When interfacing to the data memory block, EEDATA holds the 8-bit data for read/write, and EEADR holds the address of the EEPROM location being accessed. The registers EEDATH and EEADRH are not used for data EEPROM access. These devices have up to 256 bytes of data EEPROM with an address range from 0h to FFh. The EEPROM data memory is rated for high erase/ write cycles. The write time is controlled by an on-chip timer. The write time will vary with voltage and temperature as well as from chip to chip. Please refer to the specications for exact limits. The program memory allows word reads and writes. Program memory reads allow checksum calculation for UL type applications. A byte or word write automatically erases the location and writes the new data (erase before write). When interfacing to the program memory block, the EEDATH:EEDATA registers form a 2 byte word which holds the 14-bit data for read/write, and the EEADRH:EEADR registers form a 2 byte word which holds the 13-bit address of the EEPROM location being accessed. These devices can have up to 8K words of program EEPROM with an address range from 0h to 3FFFh. The value written to program memory does not need to be a valid instruction. Therefore, up to 14-bit numbers can be stored in memory for use as calibration parameters, serial numbers, packed 7-bit ASCII, etc. Executing a program memory location containing data that forms an invalid instruction results in a NOP.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 41
PIC16F87X
4.2 EECON1 and EECON2 Registers
EECON1 is the control register for memory accesses. EECON2 is not a physical register. Reading EECON2 will read all '0's. The EECON2 register is used exclusively in the memory write sequence. Control bit EEPGD determines if the access will be a program or a data memory access. When clear, any subsequent operations will operate on the data memory. When set, any subsequent operations will operate on the program memory. Control bits RD and WR initiate read and write operations, respectively. These bits cannot be cleared, only set, in software. They are cleared in hardware at the completion of the read or write operation. The inability to clear the WR bit in software prevents the accidental or premature termination of a write operation. The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation. On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is set when a write operation is interrupted by a MCLR reset or a WDT time-out reset during normal operation. In these situations, following reset, the user can check the WRERR bit and rewrite the location. The value of the data and address registers and the EEPGD bit remains unchanged. Interrupt ag bit EEIF, in the PIR2 register, is set when write is complete. It must be cleared in software.
FIGURE 4-1:
R/W-x U-0 EEPGD bit7
R= Readable bit W= Writable bit S= Settable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7:
EEPGD: Program / Data EEPROM Select bit 1 = Accesses Program memory 0 = Accesses data memory (This bit cannot be changed while a read or write operation is in progress) WRERR: EEPROM Error Flag bit 1 = A write operation is prematurely terminated (any MCLR reset or any WDT reset during normal operation) 0 = The write operation completed WREN: EEPROM Write Enable bit 1 = Allows write cycles 0 = Inhibits write to the EEPROM WR: Write Control bit 1 = initiates a write cycle. (The bit is cleared by hardware once write is complete. The WR bit can only be set (not cleared) in software. 0 = Write cycle to the EEPROM is complete RD: Read Control bit 1 = Initiates an EEPROM read (read takes one cycle. RD is cleared in hardware. The RD bit can only be set (not cleared) in software). 0 = Does not initiate an EEPROM read
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
DS30292A-page 42
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
4.3 Reading the Data EEPROM Memory
To read a data memory location, the user must write the address to the EEADR register, clear the EEPGD control bit (EECON1<7>) and then set control bit RD (EECON1<0>). The data is available, in the very next instruction cycle, in the EEDATA register; therefore it can be read by the next instruction. EEDATA will hold this value until another read operation or until it is written to by the user (during a write operation).
EXAMPLE 4-1:
BSF BCF MOVLW MOVWF BSF BCF BSF BCF MOVF
STATUS, RP1 STATUS, RP0 DATA_EE_ADDR EEADR STATUS, RP0 EECON1, EEPGD EECON1, RD STATUS, RP0 EEDATA, W
4.4
the EEDATA register. Then the sequence in Example 4-2 must be followed to initiate the write cycle.
To write an EEPROM data location, the address must rst be written to the EEADR register and the data to
EXAMPLE 4-2:
Required Sequence
The write will not initiate if the above sequence is not exactly followed (write 55h to EECON2, write AAh to EECON2, then set WR bit) for each byte. It is strongly recommended that interrupts be disabled during this code segment. Additionally, the WREN bit in EECON1 must be set to enable writes. This mechanism prevents accidental writes to data EEPROM due to unexpected code execution (i.e., lost programs). The WREN bit should be kept clear at all times, except when updating the EEPROM. The WREN bit is not cleared by hardware
After a write sequence has been initiated, clearing the WREN bit will not affect the current write cycle. The WR bit will be inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit is set. The WREN bit must be set on a previous instruction, both WR and WREN cannot be set with the same instruction. At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is cleared in hardware and the EEPROM Write Complete Interrupt Flag bit (EEIF) is set. EEIF must be cleared by software.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 43
PIC16F87X
4.5 Reading the FLASH Program Memory
A program memory location may be read by writing two bytes of the address to the EEADR and EEADRH registers, set the EEPGD control bit (EECON1<7>) and then set control bit RD (EECON1<0>). Once the read control bit is set, the microcontroller will use the second instruction cycle to read the data. This causes the second instruction immediately following the BSF EECON1,RD instruction to be ignored. The data is available, in the third cycle, in the EEDATA and EEDATH registers; therefore it can be read as two bytes in the following instructions. The data can be read out of EEDATH:EEDATA starting with the third instruction cycle after the BSF EECON1,RD instruction. The EEDATA and EEDATH registers will hold this value until another read operation or until it is written to by the user (during a write operation).
EXAMPLE 4-3:
BSF BCF MOVLW MOVWF MOVLW MOVWF BSF BSF BSF NOP NOP BCF
STATUS, RP1 STATUS, RP0 ADDRH EEADRH ADDRL EEADR STATUS, RP0 EECON1, EEPGD EECON1, RD
STATUS, RP0
; Bank 2
MOVF MOVF
EEDATA, W EEDATH, W
DS30292A-page 44
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
4.6 Writing to the FLASH Program Memory
After the BSF EECON1,WR instruction, the microcontroller will execute the next instruction and then ignore the subsequent instruction. A NOP instruction should be used in both places. The microcontroller will then halt internal operations for the TPEW (parameter D133) in which the write takes place. This is not a SLEEP mode, as the clocks and peripherals will continue to run. After the write cycle, the microcontroller will resume operation with the 3rd instruction after the EECON1 write instruction.
A word of the FLASH program memory may only be written to if the word is in a non-code protected segment of memory and the WRT conguration bit is set. To write a FLASH program location, the rst two bytes of the address must be written to the EEADR and EEADRH registers and two bytes of the data to the EEDATA and EEDATH registers, set the EEPGD control bit (EECON1<7>), and then set control bit WR (EECON1<1>). The sequence in Example 4-4 must be followed to initiate a write to program memory.
EXAMPLE 4-4:
Required Sequence
; Instructions here are ignored by the microcontroller ; Microcontroller will halt operation and wait for ; a write complete. After the write ; the microcontroller continues with 3rd instruction
BSF BCF
INTCON,
GIE
EECON1, WREN
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 45
PIC16F87X
4.7 Write Verify
4.8.2 PROGRAM FLASH MEMORY Depending on the application, good programming practice may dictate that the value written to the memory should be veried against the original value. This should be used in applications where excessive writes can stress bits near the specication limit. Generally a write failure will be a bit which was written as a '1', but reads back as a '0' (due to leakage off the bit). To protect against spurious writes to FLASH program memory, the WRT bit in the conguration word may be programmed to 0 to prevent writes. WRT and the conguration word cannot be programmed by user code, only through the use of an external programmer.
4.9
4.8
4.8.1
Each reprogrammable memory block has its own code protect mechanism. External Read and Write operations are disabled if either of these mechanisms are enabled. 4.9.3 DATA EEPROM MEMORY
There are conditions when the device may not want to write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have been built in. On power-up, the WREN bit is cleared. Also, the Power-up Timer (72 ms duration) prevents EEPROM write. The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit together help prevent an accidental write during brown-out, power glitch, or software malfunction.
The microcontroller itself can both read and write to the internal Data EEPROM regardless of the state of the code protect conguration bit. 4.9.4 PROGRAM FLASH MEMORY
The microcontroller can read and execute instructions out of the internal FLASH program memory regardless of the state of the code protect conguration bits. However the WRT conguration bit and the code protect bits have different effects on writing to program memory. Table 7-1 shows the various congurations and status of reads and writes. To erase the WRT or code protection bits in the conguration word requires that the device be fully erased.
TABLE 7-1:
Conguration Bits CP1 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 CP0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 WRT x 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 All program memory Unprotected areas Protected areas Unprotected areas Protected areas Unprotected areas Protected areas Unprotected areas Protected areas All program memory All program memory
DS30292A-page 46
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
5.0 TIMER0 MODULE
The Timer0 module timer/counter has the following features: 8-bit timer/counter Readable and writable Internal or external clock select Edge select for external clock 8-bit software programmable prescaler Interrupt on overow from FFh to 00h Additional information on external clock requirements is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, DS33023.
5.2
Prescaler
Figure 5-1 is a simplied block diagram of the Timer0 module. Additional information on timer modules is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
An 8-bit counter is available as a prescaler for the Timer0 module, or as a postscaler for the Watchdog Timer (Figure 5-2). For simplicity, this counter is being referred to as prescaler throughout this data sheet. Note that there is only one prescaler available which is mutually exclusively shared between the Timer0 module and the Watchdog Timer. Thus, a prescaler assignment for the Timer0 module means that there is no prescaler for the Watchdog Timer, and vice-versa. The prescaler is not readable or writable. The PSA and PS2:PS0 bits (OPTION_REG<3:0>) determine the prescaler assignment and prescale ratio. Clearing bit PSA will assign the prescaler to the Timer0 module. When the prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module, prescale values of 1:2, 1:4, ..., 1:256 are selectable. Setting bit PSA will assign the prescaler to the Watchdog Timer (WDT). When the prescaler is assigned to the WDT, prescale values of 1:1, 1:2, ..., 1:128 are selectable. When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions writing to the TMR0 register (e.g. CLRF TMR0, MOVWF TMR0, BSF TMR0,x....etc.) will clear the prescaler. When assigned to WDT, a CLRWDT instruction will clear the prescaler along with the WDT. Note: Writing to TMR0 when the prescaler is assigned to Timer0 will clear the prescaler count, but will not change the prescaler assignment.
5.1
Timer0 Operation
Timer0 can operate as a timer or as a counter. Timer mode is selected by clearing bit T0CS (OPTION_REG<5>). In timer mode, the Timer0 module will increment every instruction cycle (without prescaler). If the TMR0 register is written, the increment is inhibited for the following two instruction cycles. The user can work around this by writing an adjusted value to the TMR0 register. Counter mode is selected by setting bit T0CS (OPTION_REG<5>). In counter mode, Timer0 will increment either on every rising or falling edge of pin RA4/T0CKI. The incrementing edge is determined by the Timer0 Source Edge Select bit T0SE (OPTION_REG<4>). Clearing bit T0SE selects the rising edge. Restrictions on the external clock input are discussed below. When an external clock input is used for Timer0, it must meet certain requirements. The requirements ensure the external clock can be synchronized with the internal phase clock (TOSC). Also, there is a delay in the actual incrementing of Timer0 after synchronization.
FIGURE 5-1:
Programmable Prescaler
2: The prescaler is shared with Watchdog Timer (refer to Figure 5-2 for detailed block diagram).
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 47
PIC16F87X
5.2.1 SWITCHING PRESCALER ASSIGNMENT
5.3
Timer0 Interrupt
The prescaler assignment is fully under software control, i.e., it can be changed on the y during program execution. Note: To avoid an unintended device RESET, a specic instruction sequence (shown in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, DS33023) must be executed when changing the prescaler assignment from Timer0 to the WDT. This sequence must be followed even if the WDT is disabled.
The TMR0 interrupt is generated when the TMR0 register overows from FFh to 00h. This overow sets bit T0IF (INTCON<2>). The interrupt can be masked by clearing bit T0IE (INTCON<5>). Bit T0IF must be cleared in software by the Timer0 module interrupt service routine before re-enabling this interrupt. The TMR0 interrupt cannot awaken the processor from SLEEP since the timer is shut off during SLEEP.
FIGURE 5-2:
CLKOUT (=Fosc/4)
M U X
1
M
U X
SYNC 2 Cycles
TMR0 reg
T0CS PSA
0 M Watchdog Timer 1 U X
8-bit Prescaler
8 8 - to - 1MUX
PS2:PS0
TABLE 5-1
Address 01h,101h
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented locations read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by Timer0.
DS30292A-page 48
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
6.0 TIMER1 MODULE
6.1 Timer1 Operation
The Timer1 module timer/counter has the following features: 16-bit timer/counter (Two 8-bit registers; TMR1H and TMR1L) Readable and writable (Both registers) Internal or external clock select Interrupt on overow from FFFFh to 0000h Reset from CCP module trigger Timer1 has a control register, shown in Figure 6-1. Timer1 can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing control bit TMR1ON (T1CON<0>). Figure 6-3 is a simplied block diagram of the Timer1 module. Additional information on timer modules is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023). Timer1 can operate in one of these modes: As a timer As a synchronous counter As an asynchronous counter The operating mode is determined by the clock select bit, TMR1CS (T1CON<1>). In timer mode, Timer1 increments every instruction cycle. In counter mode, it increments on every rising edge of the external clock input. When the Timer1 oscillator is enabled (T1OSCEN is set), the RC1/T1OSI and RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI pins become inputs. That is, the TRISC<1:0> value is ignored. Timer1 also has an internal reset input. This reset can be generated by the CCP module (Section 8.0).
FIGURE 6-1:
U-0 bit7
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0 R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7-6: Unimplemented: Read as '0' bit 5-4: T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits 11 = 1:8 Prescale value 10 = 1:4 Prescale value 01 = 1:2 Prescale value 00 = 1:1 Prescale value bit 3: T1OSCEN: Timer1 Oscillator Enable Control bit 1 = Oscillator is enabled 0 = Oscillator is shut off Note: The oscillator inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit TMR1CS = 1 1 = Do not synchronize external clock input 0 = Synchronize external clock input TMR1CS = 0 This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock when TMR1CS = 0. bit 1: TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit 1 = External clock from pin RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI (on the rising edge) 0 = Internal clock (FOSC/4) TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit 1 = Enables Timer1 0 = Stops Timer1
bit 2:
bit 0:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 49
PIC16F87X
6.1.1 TIMER1 COUNTER OPERATION In this mode, Timer1 is being incremented via an external source. Increments occur on a rising edge. After Timer1 is enabled in counter mode, the module must rst have a falling edge before the counter begins to increment.
FIGURE 6-2:
T1CKI (Default high)
FIGURE 6-3:
1 TMR1ON on/off T1OSC RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI T1OSCEN Enable Oscillator(1) Fosc/4 Internal Clock 1 Prescaler 1, 2, 4, 8 0 2 T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0 TMR1CS SLEEP input Synchronize det T1SYNC
RC1/T1OSI
Note 1: When the T1OSCEN bit is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off. This eliminates power drain.
DS30292A-page 50
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
6.2 Timer1 Oscillator 6.3 Timer1 Interrupt
A crystal oscillator circuit is built in between pins T1OSI (input) and T1OSO (amplier output). It is enabled by setting control bit T1OSCEN (T1CON<3>). The oscillator is a low power oscillator rated up to 200 kHz. It will continue to run during SLEEP. It is primarily intended for a 32 kHz crystal. Table 6-1 shows the capacitor selection for the Timer1 oscillator. The Timer1 oscillator is identical to the LP oscillator. The user must provide a software time delay to ensure proper oscillator start-up. The TMR1 Register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments from 0000h to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. The TMR1 Interrupt, if enabled, is generated on overow which is latched in interrupt ag bit TMR1IF (PIR1<0>). This interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing TMR1 interrupt enable bit TMR1IE (PIE1<0>).
6.4
TABLE 6-1
If the CCP module is congured in compare mode to generate a special event trigger" (CCP1M3:CCP1M0 = 1011), this signal will reset Timer1, and for CCP2 only, start an A/D conversion (if the A/D module is enabled). Note: The special event triggers from the CCP1 module will not set interrupt ag bit TMR1IF (PIR1<0>).
Osc Type LP
These values are for design guidance only. Crystals Tested: 32.768 kHz 100 kHz Epson C-001R32.768K-A Epson C-2 100.00 KC-P 20 PPM 20 PPM
Timer1 must be congured for either timer or synchronized counter mode to take advantage of this feature. If Timer1 is running in asynchronous counter mode, this reset operation may not work. In the event that a write to Timer1 coincides with a special event trigger from CCP1, the write will take precedence. In this mode of operation, the CCPR1H:CCPR1L registers pair effectively becomes the period register for Timer1.
200 kHz STD XTL 200.000 kHz 20 PPM Note 1: Higher capacitance increases the stability of oscillator but also increases the start-up time.
2: Since each resonator/crystal has its own characteristics, the user should consult the resonator/crystal manufacturer for appropriate values of external components.
TABLE 6-2
Address
0Bh,8Bh, INTCON GIE 10Bh,18Bh 0Ch 8Ch 0Eh 0Fh PIR1 PIE1 TMR1L TMR1H
PEIE T0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu --uu uuuu
Holding register for the Least Signicant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register Holding register for the Most Signicant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 register
10h T1CON Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module. Note 1: These bits are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 51
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 52
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
7.0
TIMER2 MODULE
7.1
Timer2 Operation
The Timer2 module timer has the following features: 8-bit timer (TMR2 register) 8-bit period register (PR2) Readable and writable (Both registers) Software programmable prescaler (1:1, 1:4, 1:16) Software programmable postscaler (1:1 to 1:16) Interrupt on TMR2 match of PR2 SSP module optional use of TMR2 output to generate clock shift
Timer2 can be used as the PWM time-base for PWM mode of the CCP module. The TMR2 register is readable and writable, and is cleared on any device reset. The input clock (FOSC/4) has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:4 or 1:16, selected by control bits T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0 (T2CON<1:0>). The match output of TMR2 goes through a 4-bit postscaler (which gives a 1:1 to 1:16 scaling inclusive) to generate a TMR2 interrupt (latched in ag bit TMR2IF, (PIR1<1>)). The prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared when any of the following occurs: a write to the TMR2 register a write to the T2CON register any device reset TMR2 is not cleared when T2CON is written.
Timer2 has a control register, shown in Figure 7-1. Timer2 can be shut off by clearing control bit TMR2ON (T2CON<2>) to minimize power consumption. Figure 7-2 is a simplied block diagram of the Timer2 module. Additional information on timer modules is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
FIGURE 7-1:
U-0 bit7
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0 R= Readable bit W= Writable bit U= Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n= Value at POR reset
bit 7:
bit 6-3: TOUTPS3:TOUTPS0: Timer2 Output Postscale Select bits 0000 = 1:1 Postscale 0001 = 1:2 Postscale 1111 = 1:16 Postscale bit 2: TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit 1 = Timer2 is on 0 = Timer2 is off
bit 1-0: T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits 00 = Prescaler is 1 01 = Prescaler is 4 1x = Prescaler is 16
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 53
PIC16F87X
7.2 Timer2 Interrupt FIGURE 7-2:
Sets ag bit TMR2IF
The Timer2 module has an 8-bit period register PR2. Timer2 increments from 00h until it matches PR2 and then resets to 00h on the next increment cycle. PR2 is a readable and writable register. The PR2 register is initialized to FFh upon reset.
Fosc/4
7.3
Output of TMR2
EQ
The output of TMR2 (before the postscaler) is fed to the Synchronous Serial Port module which optionally uses it to generate shift clock.
PR2 reg
Note 1: TMR2 register output can be software selected by the SSP Module as a baud clock.
TABLE 7-1
Address
0Bh,8Bh, 10Bh, 18Bh 0Ch 8Ch 11h 12h 92h
Name
INTCON
Bit 6
PEIE
Bit 5
T0IE
Bit 4
INTE
Bit 3
RBIE
Bit 2
T0IF
Bit 1
INTF
Bit 0
RBIF
RCIF RCIE
TXIF TXIE
SSPIF SSPIE
CCP1IF CCP1IE
TMR2IF TMR2IE
TMR1IF TMR1IE
0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000
Timer2 modules register TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer2 module. Note 1: These bits are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30292A-page 54
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
8.0 CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM (CCP) MODULE(S)
CCP2 Module Capture/Compare/PWM Register2 (CCPR2) is comprised of two 8-bit registers: CCPR2L (low byte) and CCPR2H (high byte). The CCP2CON register controls the operation of CCP2. All are readable and writable. Additional information on the CCP module is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
Each CCP (Capture/Compare/PWM) module contains a 16-bit register which can operate as a 16-bit capture register, as a 16-bit compare register or as a PWM master/slave Duty Cycle register. Table 8-1 shows the timer resources of the CCP module modes. The operation of CCP1 is identical to that of CCP2, with the exception of the special trigger. Therefore, operation of a CCP module in the following sections is described with respect to CCP1. Table 8-2 shows the interaction of the CCP modules. CCP1 Module Capture/Compare/PWM Register1 (CCPR1) is comprised of two 8-bit registers: CCPR1L (low byte) and CCPR1H (high byte). The CCP1CON register controls the operation of CCP1. All are readable and writable.
TABLE 8-1
CCP Mode
Capture Compare PWM
TABLE 8-2
CCPx Mode CCPy Mode Capture Capture Compare PWM PWM PWM Capture Compare Compare PWM Capture Compare
FIGURE 8-1:
U-0
U-0
R/W-0 CCPxX
R/W-0 CCPxY
R/W-0 CCPxM3
R/W-0 CCPxM2
R/W-0 CCPxM1
R/W-0 CCPxM0
bit7
bit0
R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n =Value at POR reset
bit 7-6: Unimplemented: Read as '0' bit 5-4: CCPxX:CCPxY: PWM Least Signicant bits Capture Mode: Unused Compare Mode: Unused PWM Mode: These bits are the two LSbs of the PWM duty cycle. The eight MSbs are found in CCPRxL. bit 3-0: CCPxM3:CCPxM0: CCPx Mode Select bits 0000 = Capture/Compare/PWM off (resets CCPx module) 0100 = Capture mode, every falling edge 0101 = Capture mode, every rising edge 0110 = Capture mode, every 4th rising edge 0111 = Capture mode, every 16th rising edge 1000 = Compare mode, set output on match (CCPxIF bit is set) 1001 = Compare mode, clear output on match (CCPxIF bit is set) 1010 = Compare mode, generate software interrupt on match (CCPxIF bit is set, CCPx pin is unaffected) 1011 = Compare mode, trigger special event (CCPxIF bit is set; CCP1 resets TMR1; CCP2 resets TMR1 and starts an A/D conversion (if A/D module is enabled)) 11xx = PWM mode
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 55
PIC16F87X
8.1 Capture Mode
8.1.4 CCP PRESCALER In Capture mode, CCPR1H:CCPR1L captures the 16-bit value of the TMR1 register when an event occurs on pin RC2/CCP1. An event is dened as: every falling edge every rising edge every 4th rising edge every 16th rising edge There are four prescaler settings, specied by bits CCP1M3:CCP1M0. Whenever the CCP module is turned off, or the CCP module is not in capture mode, the prescaler counter is cleared. This means that any reset will clear the prescaler counter. Switching from one capture prescaler to another may generate an interrupt. Also, the prescaler counter will not be cleared, therefore the rst capture may be from a non-zero prescaler. Example 8-1 shows the recommended method for switching between capture prescalers. This example also clears the prescaler counter and will not generate the false interrupt.
An event is selected by control bits CCP1M3:CCP1M0 (CCP1CON<3:0>). When a capture is made, the interrupt request ag bit CCP1IF (PIR1<2>) is set. It must be cleared in software. If another capture occurs before the value in register CCPR1 is read, the old captured value will be lost. 8.1.1 CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
EXAMPLE 8-1:
CLRF MOVLW
In Capture mode, the RC2/CCP1 pin should be congured as an input by setting the TRISC<2> bit. Note: If the RC2/CCP1 is congured as an output, a write to the port can cause a capture condition.
CCP1CON NEW_CAPT_PS
MOVWF
CCP1CON
FIGURE 8-2:
CCPR1L
TMR1L
8.1.2
Timer1 must be running in timer mode or synchronized counter mode for the CCP module to use the capture feature. In asynchronous counter mode, the capture operation may not work. 8.1.3 SOFTWARE INTERRUPT
When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture interrupt may be generated. The user should keep bit CCP1IE (PIE1<2>) clear to avoid false interrupts and should clear the ag bit CCP1IF following any such change in operating mode.
DS30292A-page 56
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
8.2 Compare Mode
8.2.1 CCP PIN CONFIGURATION In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPR1 register value is constantly compared against the TMR1 register pair value. When a match occurs, the RC2/CCP1 pin is: driven High driven Low remains Unchanged The action on the pin is based on the value of control bits CCP1M3:CCP1M0 (CCP1CON<3:0>). At the same time, interrupt ag bit CCP1IF is set. The user must congure the RC2/CCP1 pin as an output by clearing the TRISC<2> bit. Note: Clearing the CCP1CON register will force the RC2/CCP1 compare output latch to the default low level. This is not the data latch. TIMER1 MODE SELECTION
8.2.2
FIGURE 8-3:
Timer1 must be running in Timer mode or Synchronized Counter mode if the CCP module is using the compare feature. In Asynchronous Counter mode, the compare operation may not work. 8.2.3 SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE
Special event trigger will: reset Timer1, but not set interrupt ag bit TMR1IF (PIR1<0>), and set bit GO/DONE
Special Event Trigger (CCP2 only) Set ag bit CCP1IF (PIR1<2>) CCPR1H CCPR1L Q S Output Logic match RC2/CCP1 R Pin TRISC<2> Output Enable CCP1CON<3:0> Mode Select Comparator TMR1H TMR1L
When generate software interrupt is chosen the CCP1 pin is not affected. Only a CCP interrupt is generated (if enabled). 8.2.4 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
In this mode, an internal hardware trigger is generated which may be used to initiate an action. The special event trigger output of CCP1 resets the TMR1 register pair. This allows the CCPR1 register to effectively be a 16-bit programmable period register for Timer1. The special trigger output of CCP2 resets the TMR1 register pair, and starts an A/D conversion (if the A/D module is enabled). Note: The special event trigger from the CCP2 module will not set interrupt ag bit TMR1IF (PIR1<0>).
TABLE 8-3
Address
0Bh,8Bh, 10Bh,18Bh 0Ch 8Ch 87h 0Eh 0Fh 10h 15h 16h 17h
GIE
PEIE T0IE
T0IF
INTF
RBIF
CCP1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 CCP1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON --00 0000 --uu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0 --00 0000 --00 0000
CCP1X
CCP1Y
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by Capture and Timer1. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 57
PIC16F87X
8.3 PWM Mode
8.3.1 PWM PERIOD In Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) mode, the CCP1 pin produces up to a 10-bit resolution PWM output. Since the CCP1 pin is multiplexed with the PORTC data latch, the TRISC<2> bit must be cleared to make the CCP1 pin an output. Note: Clearing the CCP1CON register will force the CCP1 PWM output latch to the default low level. This is not the PORTC I/O data latch. The PWM period is specied by writing to the PR2 register. The PWM period can be calculated using the following formula: PWM period = [(PR2) + 1] 4 TOSC (TMR2 prescale value) PWM frequency is dened as 1 / [PWM period]. When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events occur on the next increment cycle: TMR2 is cleared The CCP1 pin is set (exception: if PWM duty cycle = 0%, the CCP1 pin will not be set) The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR1L into CCPR1H Note: The Timer2 postscaler (see Section 7.0) is not used in the determination of the PWM frequency. The postscaler could be used to have a servo update rate at a different frequency than the PWM output. PWM DUTY CYCLE
Figure 8-4 shows a simplied block diagram of the CCP module in PWM mode. For a step by step procedure on how to set up the CCP module for PWM operation, see Section 8.3.3.
FIGURE 8-4:
8.3.2
CCPR1H (Slave)
Comparator
Q RC2/CCP1
TMR2
The PWM duty cycle is specied by writing to the CCPR1L register and to the CCP1CON<5:4> bits. Up to 10-bit resolution is available: the CCPR1L contains the eight MSbs and the CCP1CON<5:4> contains the two LSbs. This 10-bit value is represented by CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4>. The following equation is used to calculate the PWM duty cycle in time: PWM duty cycle = (CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4>) Tosc (TMR2 prescale value) CCPR1L and CCP1CON<5:4> can be written to at any time, but the duty cycle value is not latched into CCPR1H until after a match between PR2 and TMR2 occurs (i.e., the period is complete). In PWM mode, CCPR1H is a read-only register. The CCPR1H register and a 2-bit internal latch are used to double buffer the PWM duty cycle. This double buffering is essential for glitchless PWM operation. When the CCPR1H and 2-bit latch match TMR2 concatenated with an internal 2-bit Q clock or 2 bits of the TMR2 prescaler, the CCP1 pin is cleared. Maximum PWM resolution (bits) for a given PWM frequency:
log =
Comparator
PR2
Note 1: 8-bit timer is concatenated with 2-bit internal Q clock or 2 bits of the prescaler to create 10-bit time-base.
A PWM output (Figure 8-5) has a time base (period) and a time that the output stays high (duty cycle). The frequency of the PWM is the inverse of the period (1/period).
FIGURE 8-5:
PWM OUTPUT
Period
Fosc Fpwm
)
bits
log (2)
Note:
If the PWM duty cycle value is longer than the PWM period the CCP1 pin will not be cleared.
For an example PWM period and duty cycle calculation, see the Midrange Reference Manual (DS33023).
DS30292A-page 58
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
8.3.3 SET-UP FOR PWM OPERATION The following steps should be taken when conguring the CCP module for PWM operation: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Set the PWM period by writing to the PR2 register. Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the CCPR1L register and CCP1CON<5:4> bits. Make the CCP1 pin an output by clearing the TRISC<2> bit. Set the TMR2 prescale value and enable Timer2 by writing to T2CON. Congure the CCP1 module for PWM operation.
TABLE 8-4
TABLE 8-5
Address
Bit 6
PEIE ADIF ADIE
Bit 5
T0IE RCIF RCIE
Bit 4
INTE TXIF TXIE
Bit 3
RBIE SSPIF SSPIE
Bit 2
T0IF CCP1IF CCP1IE
Bit 1
INTF TMR2IF TMR2IE
Bit 0
RBIF TMR1IF TMR1IE
0Bh,8Bh, INTCON 10Bh,18Bh 0Ch 8Ch 87h 11h 92h 12h 15h 16h 17h PIR1 PIE1 TRISC TMR2 PR2 T2CON CCPR1L CCPR1H CCP1CON
PORTC Data Direction Register Timer2 modules register Timer2 modules period register TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
Capture/Compare/PWM register1 (LSB) Capture/Compare/PWM register1 (MSB) CCP1X CCP1Y CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0
--00 0000
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by PWM and Timer2. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 59
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 60
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
9.0 MASTER SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL PORT (MSSP) MODULE
The Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) module is a serial interface useful for communicating with other peripheral or microcontroller devices. These peripheral devices may be serial EEPROMs, shift registers, display drivers, A/D converters, etc. The MSSP module can operate in one of two modes: Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Inter-Integrated Circuit (I 2C) Figure 9-1 shows a block diagram for the SPI mode, while Figure 9-2, and Figure 9-3 shows the block diagrams for the two different I2C modes of operation.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 61
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-1:
R/W-0 R/W-0 SMP CKE bit7
R =Readable bit W =Writable bit U =Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
SMP: Sample bit SPI Master Mode 1 = Input data sampled at end of data output time 0 = Input data sampled at middle of data output time SPI Slave Mode SMP must be cleared when SPI is used in slave mode In I2C master or slave mode: 1= Slew rate control disabled for standard speed mode (100 kHz and 1 MHz) 0= Slew rate control enabled for high speed mode (400 kHz) CKE: SPI Clock Edge Select (Figure 9-6, Figure 9-8, and Figure 9-9) SPI Mode: CKP = 0 1 = Data transmitted on rising edge of SCK 0 = Data transmitted on falling edge of SCK CKP = 1 1 = Data transmitted on falling edge of SCK 0 = Data transmitted on rising edge of SCK In I2C Master or Slave Mode: 1 = Input levels conform to SMBUS spec 0 = Input levels conform to I2C specs D/A: Data/Address bit (I2C mode only) 1 = Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was data 0 = Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was address P: Stop bit (I2C mode only. This bit is cleared when the MSSP module is disabled, SSPEN is cleared) 1 = Indicates that a stop bit has been detected last (this bit is '0' on RESET) 0 = Stop bit was not detected last S: Start bit (I2C mode only. This bit is cleared when the MSSP module is disabled, SSPEN is cleared) 1 = Indicates that a start bit has been detected last (this bit is '0' on RESET) 0 = Start bit was not detected last R/W: Read/Write bit information (I2C mode only) This bit holds the R/W bit information following the last address match. This bit is only valid from the address match to the next start bit, stop bit, or not ACK bit. In I2C slave mode: 1 = Read 0 = Write In I2C master mode: 1 = Transmit is in progress 0 = Transmit is not in progress. Oring this bit with SEN, RSEN, PEN, RCEN, or ACKEN will indicate if the MSSP is in IDLE mode. UA: Update Address (10-bit I2C mode only) 1 = Indicates that the user needs to update the address in the SSPADD register 0 = Address does not need to be updated BF: Buffer Full Status bit Receive (SPI and I2C modes) 1 = Receive complete, SSPBUF is full 0 = Receive not complete, SSPBUF is empty Transmit (I2C mode only) 1 = Data Transmit in progress (does not include the ACK and stop bits), SSPBUF is full 0 = Data Transmit complete (does not include the ACK and stop bits), SSPBUF is empty
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
DS30292A-page 62
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-2:
R/W-0 WCOL bit7 bit 7:
R/W-0 SSPOV
WCOL: Write Collision Detect bit Master Mode: 1 = A write to SSPBUF was attempted while the I2C conditions were not valid 0 = No collision Slave Mode: 1 = SSPBUF register is written while still transmitting the previous word (must be cleared in software) 0 = No collision SSPOV: Receive Overow Indicator bit In SPI mode 1 = A new byte is received while SSPBUF holds previous data. Data in SSPSR is lost on overow. . In slave mode the user must read the SSPBUF, even if only transmitting data, to avoid overows. In master mode the overow bit is not set since each operation is initiated by writing to the SSPBUF register. (Must be cleared in software). 0 = No overow In I2C mode 1 = A byte is received while the SSPBUF is holding the previous byte. SSPOV is a "dont care" in transmit mode. (Must be cleared in software). 0 = No overow SSPEN: Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit In SPI mode, when enabled, these pins must be properly congured as input or output. 1 = Enables serial port and congures SCK, SDO, SDI, and SS as the source of the serial port pins 0 = Disables serial port and congures these pins as I/O port pins In I2C mode, when enabled, these pins must be properly congured as input or output. 1 = Enables the serial port and congures the SDA and SCL pins as the source of the serial port pins 0 = Disables serial port and congures these pins as I/O port pins CKP: Clock Polarity Select bit In SPI mode 1 = Idle state for clock is a high level 0 = Idle state for clock is a low level In I2C slave mode, SCK release control 1 = Enable clock 0 = Holds clock low (clock stretch) (Used to ensure data setup time) In I2C master mode Unused in this mode
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3-0: SSPM3:SSPM0: Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits 0000 = SPI master mode, clock = FOSC/4 0001 = SPI master mode, clock = FOSC/16 0010 = SPI master mode, clock = FOSC/64 0011 = SPI master mode, clock = TMR2 output/2 0100 = SPI slave mode, clock = SCK pin. SS pin control enabled. 0101 = SPI slave mode, clock = SCK pin. SS pin control disabled. SS can be used as I/O pin 0110 = I2C slave mode, 7-bit address 0111 = I2C slave mode, 10-bit address 1000 = I2C master mode, clock = FOSC / (4 * (SSPADD+1) ) 1011 = I2C firmware controlled master mode (slave idle) 1110 = I2C firmware controlled master mode, 7-bit address with start and stop bit interrupts enabled 1111 = I2C firmware controlled master mode, 10-bit address with start and stop bit interrupts enabled. 1001, 1010, 1100, 1101 = reserved
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 63
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-3:
R/W-0 GCEN bit7
R/W-0 ACKSTAT
R =Readable bit W =Writable bit U =Unimplemented bit, Read as 0 - n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
GCEN: General Call Enable bit (In I2C slave mode only) 1 = Enable interrupt when a general call address (0000h) is received in the SSPSR. 0 = General call address disabled. ACKSTAT: Acknowledge Status bit (In I2C master mode only) In master transmit mode: 1 = Acknowledge was not received from slave 0 = Acknowledge was received from slave ACKDT: Acknowledge Data bit (In I2C master mode only) In master receive mode: Value that will be transmitted when the user initiates an Acknowledge sequence at the end of a receive. 1 = Not Acknowledge 0 = Acknowledge ACKEN: Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit (In I2C master mode only). In master receive mode: 1 = Initiate Acknowledge sequence on SDA and SCL pins, and transmit ACKDT data bit. Automatically cleared by hardware. 0 = Acknowledge sequence idle RCEN: Receive Enable bit (In I2C master mode only). 1 = Enables Receive mode for I2C 0 = Receive idle PEN: Stop Condition Enable bit (In I2C master mode only). SCK release control 1 = Initiate Stop condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware. 0 = Stop condition idle RSEN: Repeated Start Condition Enabled bit (In I2C master mode only) 1 = Initiate Repeated Start condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware. 0 = Repeated Start condition idle. SEN: Start Condition Enabled bit (In I2C master mode only) 1 = Initiate Start condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware. 0 = Start condition idle. For bits ACKEN, RCEN, PEN, RSEN, SEN: If the I2C module is not in the idle mode, this bit may not be set (no spooling), and the SSPBUF may not be written (or writes to the SSPBUF are disabled).
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
Note:
DS30292A-page 64
PIC16F87X
9.1 SPI Mode FIGURE 9-4:
The SPI mode allows 8-bits of data to be synchronously transmitted and received simultaneously. All four modes of SPI are supported. To accomplish communication, typically three pins are used: Serial Data Out (SDO) Serial Data In (SDI) Serial Clock (SCK) Additionally a fourth pin may be used when in a slave mode of operation: Slave Select (SS) 9.1.1 OPERATION
SDI SDO bit0
When initializing the SPI, several options need to be specied. This is done by programming the appropriate control bits (SSPCON<5:0> and SSPSTAT<7:6>). These control bits allow the following to be specied: Master Mode (SCK is the clock output) Slave Mode (SCK is the clock input) Clock Polarity (Idle state of SCK) Data input sample phase (middle or end of data output time) Clock edge (output data on rising/falling edge of SCK) Clock Rate (Master mode only) Slave Select Mode (Slave mode only) Figure 9-4 shows the block diagram of the MSSP module when in SPI mode.
SS
SS Control Enable Edge Select 2 Clock Select SSPM3:SSPM0 SMP:CKE 4 TMR2 output 2 2 Edge Select Prescaler TOSC 4, 16, 64 Data to TX/RX in SSPSR Data direction bit
SCK
The MSSP consists of a transmit/receive Shift Register (SSPSR) and a buffer register (SSPBUF). The SSPSR shifts the data in and out of the device, MSb rst. The SSPBUF holds the data that was written to the SSPSR, until the received data is ready. Once the 8-bits of data have been received, that byte is moved to the SSPBUF register. Then the buffer full detect bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) and the interrupt ag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) are set. This double buffering of the received data (SSPBUF) allows the next byte to start reception before reading the data that was just received. Any write to the SSPBUF register during transmission/ reception of data will be ignored, and the write collision detect bit WCOL (SSPCON<7>) will be set. User software must clear the WCOL bit so that it can be determined if the following write(s) to the SSPBUF register completed successfully. When the application software is expecting to receive valid data, the SSPBUF should be read before the next byte of data to transfer is written to the SSPBUF. Buffer full bit, BF (SSPSTAT<0>), indicates when the SSPBUF has been loaded with the received data (transmission is complete). When the SSPBUF is read, bit BF is cleared. This data may be irrelevant if the SPI is only a transmitter. Generally the MSSP Interrupt is used to
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 65
PIC16F87X
determine when the transmission/reception has completed. The SSPBUF must be read and/or written. If the interrupt method is not going to be used, then software polling can be done to ensure that a write collision does not occur. Example 9-1 shows the loading of the SSPBUF (SSPSR) for data transmission. SDO, SCK, and SS pins as serial port pins. For the pins to behave as the serial port function, some must have their data direction bits (in the TRIS register) appropriately programmed. That is: SDI is automatically controlled by the SPI module SDO must have TRISC<5> cleared SCK (Master mode) must have TRISC<3> cleared SCK (Slave mode) must have TRISC<3> set SS must have TRISA<5> set Any serial port function that is not desired may be overridden by programming the corresponding data direction (TRIS) register to the opposite value. 9.1.3 TYPICAL CONNECTION
EXAMPLE 9-1:
The SSPSR is not directly readable or writable, and can only be accessed by addressing the SSPBUF register. Additionally, the MSSP status register (SSPSTAT) indicates the various status conditions. 9.1.2 ENABLING SPI I/O
Figure 9-5 shows a typical connection between two microcontrollers. The master controller (Processor 1) initiates the data transfer by sending the SCK signal. Data is shifted out of both shift registers on their programmed clock edge, and latched on the opposite edge of the clock. Both processors should be programmed to same Clock Polarity (CKP), then both controllers would send and receive data at the same time. Whether the data is meaningful (or dummy data) depends on the application software. This leads to three scenarios for data transmission: Master sends data Slave sends dummy data Master sends data Slave sends data Master sends dummy data Slave sends data
To enable the serial port, MSSP Enable bit, SSPEN (SSPCON<5>) must be set. To reset or recongure SPI mode, clear bit SSPEN, re-initialize the SSPCON registers, and then set bit SSPEN. This congures the SDI,
FIGURE 9-5:
SDI
SDO
Serial Clock
SCK PROCESSOR 1 SCK PROCESSOR 2
DS30292A-page 66
PIC16F87X
9.1.4 MASTER MODE The master can initiate the data transfer at any time because it controls the SCK. The master determines when the slave (Processor 2, Figure 9-5) is to broadcast data by the software protocol. In master mode the data is transmitted/received as soon as the SSPBUF register is written to. If the SPI module is only going to receive, the SDO output could be disabled (programmed as an input). The SSPSR register will continue to shift in the signal present on the SDI pin at the programmed clock rate. As each byte is received, it will be loaded into the SSPBUF register as if a normal received byte (interrupts and status bits appropriately set). This could be useful in receiver applications as a line activity monitor. The clock polarity is selected by appropriately programming bit CKP (SSPCON<4>). This then would give waveforms for SPI communication as shown in Figure 9-6, Figure 9-8, and Figure 9-9 where the MSb is transmitted rst. In master mode, the SPI clock rate (bit rate) is user programmable to be one of the following: FOSC/4 (or TCY) FOSC/16 (or 4 TCY) FOSC/64 (or 16 TCY) Timer2 output/2
This allows a maximum bit clock frequency (at 20 MHz) of 5.0 MHz. Figure 9-6 shows the waveforms for Master mode. When CKE = 1, the SDO data is valid before there is a clock edge on SCK. The change of the input sample is shown based on the state of the SMP bit. The time when the SSPBUF is loaded with the received data is shown.
FIGURE 9-6:
Write to SSPBUF SCK (CKP = 0 CKE = 0) SCK (CKP = 1 CKE = 0) SCK (CKP = 0 CKE = 1) SCK (CKP = 1 CKE = 1) SDO (CKE = 0) SDO (CKE = 1) SDI (SMP = 0) Input Sample (SMP = 0) SDI (SMP = 1) Input Sample (SMP = 1) SSPIF SSPSR to SSPBUF
4 clock modes
bit7 bit7
bit6 bit6
bit5 bit5
bit4 bit4
bit3 bit3
bit2 bit2
bit1 bit1
bit0 bit0
bit7
bit0
bit7
bit0
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 67
PIC16F87X
9.1.5 SLAVE MODE In slave mode, the data is transmitted and received as the external clock pulses appear on SCK. When the last bit is latched the interrupt ag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) is set. While in slave mode the external clock is supplied by the external clock source on the SCK pin. This external clock must meet the minimum high and low times as specied in the electrical specications. While in sleep mode, the slave can transmit/receive data. When a byte is received the device will wake-up from sleep. 9.1.6 SLAVE SELECT SYNCHRONIZATION SDO pin is no longer driven, even if in the middle of a transmitted byte, and becomes a oating output. External pull-up/ pull-down resistors may be desirable, depending on the application. Note: When the SPI module is in Slave Mode with SS pin control enabled, (SSPCON<3:0> = 0100) the SPI module will reset if the SS pin is set to VDD. If the SPI is used in Slave Mode with CKE = '1', then SS pin control must be enabled.
Note:
When the SPI module resets, the bit counter is forced to 0. This can be done by either forcing the SS pin to a high level or clearing the SSPEN bit. To emulate two-wire communication, the SDO pin can be connected to the SDI pin. When the SPI needs to operate as a receiver the SDO pin can be congured as an input. This disables transmissions from the SDO. The SDI can always be left as an input (SDI function) since it cannot create a bus conict.
The SS pin allows a synchronous slave mode. The SPI must be in slave mode with SS pin control enabled (SSPCON<3:0> = 0100). The pin must not be driven low for the SS pin to function as an input. TRISA<5> must be set. When the SS pin is low, transmission and reception are enabled and the SDO pin is driven. When the SS pin goes high, the
FIGURE 9-7:
SS
Write to SSPBUF
SDO
bit7
bit6
bit7
bit0
SDI (SMP = 0) Input Sample (SMP = 0) SSPIF Interrupt Flag SSPSR to SSPBUF
DS30292A-page 68
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-8:
SS optional SCK (CKP = 0 CKE = 0) SCK (CKP = 1 CKE = 0) Write to SSPBUF SDO SDI (SMP = 0) Input Sample (SMP = 0) SSPIF Interrupt Flag SSPSR to SSPBUF bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0
bit7
bit0
FIGURE 9-9:
SS not optional SCK (CKP = 0 CKE = 1) SCK (CKP = 1 CKE = 1) Write to SSPBUF SDO SDI (SMP = 0) Input Sample (SMP = 0) SSPIF Interrupt Flag SSPSR to SSPBUF
bit7
bit6
bit5
bit4
bit3
bit2
bit1
bit0
bit7
bit0
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 69
PIC16F87X
9.1.7 SLEEP OPERATION In master mode all module clocks are halted, and the transmission/reception will remain in that state until the device wakes from sleep. After the device returns to normal mode, the module will continue to transmit/ receive data. In slave mode, the SPI transmit/receive shift register operates asynchronously to the device. This allows the device to be placed in sleep mode, and data to be shifted into the SPI transmit/receive shift register. When all 8-bits have been received, the MSSP interrupt ag bit will be set and if enabled will wake the device from sleep. 9.1.8 EFFECTS OF A RESET
A reset disables the MSSP module and terminates the current transfer.
TABLE 9-1
Address 0Bh, 8Bh, 10Bh,18Bh 0Ch 8Ch 13h 14h 94h Legend: Note 1:
POR, BOR 0000 000x 0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx
MCLR, WDT 0000 000u 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu 0000 0000 0000 0000
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register WCOL SMP SSPOV CKE SSPEN D/A CKP P SSPM3 S SSPM2 R/W SSPM1 UA SSPM0 BF
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the SSP in SPI mode. These bits are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30292A-page 70
PIC16F87X
9.2 MSSP I 2C Operation
The MSSP module in I 2C mode fully implements all master and slave functions (including general call support) and provides interrupts on start and stop bits in hardware to determine a free bus (multi-master function). The MSSP module implements the standard mode specications as well as 7-bit and 10-bit addressing. Refer to Application Note AN578, "Use of the SSP Module in the I 2C Multi-Master Environment." A "glitch" lter is on the SCL and SDA pins when the pin is an input. This lter operates in both the 100 kHz and 400 kHz modes. In the 100 kHz mode, when these pins are an output, there is a slew rate control of the pin that is independant of device frequency.
SCL
Match detect
SSPADD reg Start and Stop bit detect / generate Set/Clear S bit and Clear/Set P bit (SSPSTAT reg) and Set SSPIF
SCL
Match detect
Two pins are used for data transfer. These are the SCL pin, which is the clock, and the SDA pin, which is the data. The SDA and SCL pins that are automatically congured when the I2C mode is enabled. The SSP module functions are enabled by setting SSP Enable bit SSPEN (SSPCON<5>). The MSSP module has six registers for I2C operation. They are the:
SSPADD reg Start and Stop bit detect Set, Reset S, P bits (SSPSTAT reg)
SSP Control Register (SSPCON) SSP Control Register2 (SSPCON2) SSP Status Register (SSPSTAT) Serial Receive/Transmit Buffer (SSPBUF) SSP Shift Register (SSPSR) - Not directly accessible SSP Address Register (SSPADD)
The SSPCON register allows control of the I 2C operation. Four mode selection bits (SSPCON<3:0>) allow one of the following I 2C modes to be selected: I 2C Slave mode (7-bit address) I 2C Slave mode (10-bit address) I 2C Master mode, clock = OSC/4 (SSPADD +1) Before selecting any I 2C mode, the SCL and SDA pins must be programmed to inputs by setting the appropriate TRIS bits. Selecting an I 2C mode, by setting the SSPEN bit, enables the SCL and SDA pins to be used as the clock and data lines in I 2C mode. The CKE bit (SSPSTAT<67>) sets the levels of the SDA and SCL pins in either master or slave mode. When CKE = 1, the levels will conform to the SMBUS specication. When CKE = 0, the levels will conform to the I2C specication.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 71
PIC16F87X
The SSPSTAT register gives the status of the data transfer. This information includes detection of a START (S) or STOP (P) bit, species if the received byte was data or address if the next byte is the completion of 10-bit address, and if this will be a read or write data transfer. SSPBUF is the register to which the transfer data is written to or read from. The SSPSR register shifts the data in or out of the device. In receive operations, the SSPBUF and SSPSR create a doubled buffered receiver. This allows reception of the next byte to begin before reading the last byte of received data. When the complete byte is received, it is transferred to the SSPBUF register and ag bit SSPIF is set. If another complete byte is received before the SSPBUF register is read, a receiver overow has occurred and bit SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) is set and the byte in the SSPSR is lost. The SSPADD register holds the slave address. In 10-bit mode, the user needs to write the high byte of the address (1111 0 A9 A8 0). Following the high byte address match, the low byte of the address needs to be loaded (A7:A0). 9.2.1 SLAVE MODE 9.2.1.1 ADDRESSING Once the MSSP module has been enabled, it waits for a START condition to occur. Following the START condition, the 8-bits are shifted into the SSPSR register. All incoming bits are sampled with the rising edge of the clock (SCL) line. The value of register SSPSR<7:1> is compared to the value of the SSPADD register. The address is compared on the falling edge of the eighth clock (SCL) pulse. If the addresses match, and the BF and SSPOV bits are clear, the following events occur: a) The SSPSR register value is loaded into the SSPBUF register on the falling edge of the 8th SCL pulse. The buffer full bit, BF is set on the falling edge of the 8th SCL pulse. An ACK pulse is generated. SSP interrupt ag bit, SSPIF (PIR1<3>) is set (interrupt is generated if enabled) - on the falling edge of the 9th SCL pulse.
b) c) d)
In slave mode, the SCL and SDA pins must be congured as inputs. The MSSP module will override the input state with the output data when required (slavetransmitter). When an address is matched or the data transfer after an address match is received, the hardware automatically will generate the acknowledge (ACK) pulse, and then load the SSPBUF register with the received value currently in the SSPSR register. There are certain conditions that will cause the MSSP module not to give this ACK pulse. These are if either (or both): a) b) The buffer full bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) was set before the transfer was received. The overow bit SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) was set before the transfer was received.
In 10-bit address mode, two address bytes need to be received by the slave. The ve Most Signicant bits (MSbs) of the rst address byte specify if this is a 10-bit address. Bit R/W (SSPSTAT<2>) must specify a write so the slave device will receive the second address byte. For a 10-bit address the rst byte would equal 1111 0 A9 A8 0, where A9 and A8 are the two MSbs of the address. The sequence of events for a 10-bit address is as follows, with steps 7- 9 for slave-transmitter: 1. 2. Receive rst (high) byte of Address (bits SSPIF, BF, and bit UA (SSPSTAT<1>) are set). Update the SSPADD register with second (low) byte of Address (clears bit UA and releases the SCL line). Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and clear ag bit SSPIF. Receive second (low) byte of Address (bits SSPIF, BF, and UA are set). Update the SSPADD register with the rst (high) byte of Address. This will clear bit UA and release the SCL line. Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and clear ag bit SSPIF. Receive Repeated Start condition. Receive rst (high) byte of Address (bits SSPIF and BF are set). Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and clear ag bit SSPIF. Note: Following the Repeated Start condition (step 7) in 10-bit mode, the user only needs to match the rst 7-bit address. The user does not update the SSPADD for the second half of the address.
3. 4. 5.
If the BF bit is set, the SSPSR register value is not loaded into the SSPBUF, but bit SSPIF and SSPOV are set. Table 9-2 shows what happens when a data transfer byte is received, given the status of bits BF and SSPOV. The shaded cells show the condition where user software did not properly clear the overow condition. Flag bit BF is cleared by reading the SSPBUF register while bit SSPOV is cleared through software. The SCL clock input must have a minimum high and low time for proper operation. The high and low times of the I2C specication as well as the requirement of the MSSP module is shown in timing parameter #100 and parameter #101 of the Electrical Specications.
6. 7. 8. 9.
DS30292A-page 72
PIC16F87X
9.2.1.2 SLAVE RECEPTION When the R/W bit of the address byte is clear and an address match occurs, the R/W bit of the SSPSTAT register is cleared. The received address is loaded into the SSPBUF register. When the address byte overow condition exists, then no acknowledge (ACK) pulse is given. An overow condition is dened as either bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) is set or bit SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) is set. An SSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer byte. Flag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) must be cleared in software. The SSPSTAT register is used to determine the status of the received byte. Note: The SSPBUF will be loaded if the SSPOV bit is set and the BF ag is cleared. If a read of the SSPBUF was performed, but the user did not clear the state of the SSPOV bit before the next receive occurred. The ACK is not sent and the SSPBUF is updated.
TABLE 9-2
Status Bits as Data Transfer is Received BF SSPOV SSPSR SSPBUF Generate ACK Pulse
0 0 Yes Yes Yes 1 0 No No Yes 1 1 No No Yes 0 1 Yes No Yes Note 1: Shaded cells show the conditions where the user software did not properly clear the overow condition. 9.2.1.3 SLAVE TRANSMISSION An SSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer byte. The SSPIF ag bit must be cleared in software, and the SSPSTAT register is used to determine the status of the byte transfer. The SSPIF ag bit is set on the falling edge of the ninth clock pulse. As a slave-transmitter, the ACK pulse from the masterreceiver is latched on the rising edge of the ninth SCL input pulse. If the SDA line was high (not ACK), then the data transfer is complete. When the not ACK is latched by the slave, the slave logic is reset and the slave then monitors for another occurrence of the START bit. If the SDA line was low (ACK), the transmit data must be loaded into the SSPBUF register, which also loads the SSPSR register. Then the SCL pin should be enabled by setting the CKP bit.
When the R/W bit of the incoming address byte is set and an address match occurs, the R/W bit of the SSPSTAT register is set. The received address is loaded into the SSPBUF register. The ACK pulse will be sent on the ninth bit, and the SCL pin is held low. The transmit data must be loaded into the SSPBUF register, which also loads the SSPSR register. Then the SCL pin should be enabled by setting bit CKP (SSPCON<4>). The master must monitor the SCL pin prior to asserting another clock pulse. The slave devices may be holding off the master by stretching the clock. The eight data bits are shifted out on the falling edge of the SCL input. This ensures that the SDA signal is valid during the SCL high time (Figure 9-13).
SCL SSPIF
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
SSPOV (SSPCON<6>) Bit SSPOV is set because the SSPBUF register is still full. ACK is not sent.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 73
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-13: I 2C WAVEFORMS FOR TRANSMISSION (7-BIT ADDRESS)
Receiving Address SDA A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 R/W = 1 ACK D7 D6 D5 D4 Transmitting Data D3 D2 D1 D0 R/W = 0 Not ACK
SCL
1 2 Data in sampled
SSPIF BF (SSPSTAT<0>) cleared in software SSPBUF is written in software CKP (SSPCON<4>) Set bit after writing to SSPBUF (the SSPBUF must be written-to before the CKP bit can be set) From SSP interrupt service routine
DS30292A-page 74
SDA
SCL
SSPIF
Preliminary
(PIR1<3>)
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
UA (SSPSTAT<1>)
PIC16F87X
DS30292A-page 75
DS30292A-page 76
Clock is held low until update of SSPADD has tACKEN place R/W = 0 A8 ACK A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 D7 D6 D5 D4 ACK D3 Receive Second Byte of Address Receive Data Byte D2 D1 R/W = 1 D0 ACK Bus Master terminates transfer 1 1 0 A9 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 P Cleared in software Cleared in software SSPBUF is written with contents of SSPSR Dummy read of SSPBUF to clear BF ag Dummy read of SSPBUF to clear BF ag Read of SSPBUF clears BF ag UA is set indicating that the SSPADD needs to be updated Cleared by hardware when SSPADD is updated with low byte of address. UA is set indicating that SSPADD needs to be updated Cleared by hardware when SSPADD is updated with high byte of address.
PIC16F87X
SDA
SCL
SSPIF
(PIR1<3>)
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
UA (SSPSTAT<1>)
PIC16F87X
9.2.2 GENERAL CALL ADDRESS SUPPORT The addressing procedure for the I2C bus is such that the rst byte after the START condition usually determines which device will be the slave addressed by the master. The exception is the general call address which can address all devices. When this address is used, all devices should, in theory, respond with an acknowledge. The general call address is one of eight addresses reserved for specic purposes by the I2C protocol. It consists of all 0s with R/W = 0 The general call address is recognized when the General Call Enable bit (GCEN) is enabled (SSPCON2<7> is set). Following a start-bit detect, 8-bits are shifted into SSPSR and the address is compared against SSPADD, and is also compared to the general call address, xed in hardware. If the general call address matches, the SSPSR is transferred to the SSPBUF, the BF ag is set (eighth bit), and on the falling edge of the ninth bit (ACK bit) the SSPIF ag is set. When the interrupt is serviced. The source for the interrupt can be checked by reading the contents of the SSPBUF to determine if the address was device specic or a general call address. In 10-bit mode, the SSPADD is required to be updated for the second half of the address to match, and the UA bit is set (SSPSTAT<1>). If the general call address is sampled when GCEN is set while the slave is congured in 10-bit address mode, then the second half of the address is not necessary, the UA bit will not be set, and the slave will begin receiving data after the acknowledge (Figure 9-16).
FIGURE 9-16: SLAVE MODE GENERAL CALL ADDRESS SEQUENCE (7 OR 10-BIT MODE)
Address is compared to General Call Address after ACK, set interrupt ag R/W = 0 ACK D7 Receiving data D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 ACK
'1'
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 77
PIC16F87X
9.2.3 SLEEP OPERATION 9.2.4 EFFECTS OF A RESET While in sleep mode, the I2C module can receive addresses or data, and when an address match or complete byte transfer occurs wake the processor from sleep (if the SSP interrupt is enabled). A reset disables the SSP module and terminates the current transfer.
TABLE 9-3
Address 0Bh, 8Bh, 10Bh,18Bh 0Ch 8Ch 0Dh 8Dh 13h 14h 91h 94h Legend:
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register WCOL GCEN SMP SSPOV ACKSTAT CKE SSPEN ACKDT D/A CKP ACKEN P SSPM3 RCEN S
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the SSP in I2C mode.
Note 1: These bits are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear. 2: These bits are reserved on these devices, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30292A-page 78
PIC16F87X
9.2.5 MASTER MODE Master mode of operation is supported by interrupt generation on the detection of the START and STOP conditions. The STOP (P) and START (S) bits are cleared from a reset or when the MSSP module is disabled. Control of the I 2C bus may be TACKEN when the P bit is set, or the bus is idle with both the S and P bits clear. In master mode, the SCL and SDA lines are manipulated by the MSSP hardware. The following events will cause SSP Interrupt Flag bit, SSPIF, to be set (SSP Interrupt if enabled): START condition STOP condition Data transfer byte transmitted/received Acknowledge transmit Repeated Start
SCL
Start bit detect, Stop bit detect Write collision detect Clock Arbitration State counter for end of XMIT/RCV
Set/Reset, S, P, WCOL (SSPSTAT) Set SSPIF, BCLIF Reset ACKSTAT, PEN (SSPCON2)
Preliminary
clock cntl
PIC16F87X
9.2.6 MULTI-MASTER MODE 9.2.7.4 I2C MASTER MODE OPERATION In multi-master mode, the interrupt generation on the detection of the START and STOP conditions allows the determination of when the bus is free. The STOP (P) and START (S) bits are cleared from a reset or when the MSSP module is disabled. Control of the I 2C bus may be TACKEN when bit P (SSPSTAT<4>) is set, or the bus is idle with both the S and P bits clear. When the bus is busy, enabling the SSP Interrupt will generate the interrupt when the STOP condition occurs. In multi-master operation, the SDA line must be monitored, for abitration, to see if the signal level is the expected output level. This check is performed in hardware, with the result placed in the BCLIF bit. The states where arbitration can be lost are: Address Transfer Data Transfer A Start Condition A Repeated Start Condition An Acknowledge Condition I2C MASTER MODE SUPPORT The master device generates all of the serial clock pulses and the START and STOP conditions. A transfer is ended with a STOP condition or with a Repeated Start condition. Since the Repeated Start condition is also the beginning of the next serial transfer, the I2C bus will not be released. In Master Transmitter mode serial data is output through SDA, while SCL outputs the serial clock. The rst byte transmitted contains the slave address of the receiving device, (7 bits) and the Read/Write (R/W) bit. In this case the R/W bit will be logic '0'. Serial data is transmitted 8 bits at a time. After each byte is transmitted, an acknowledge bit is received. START and STOP conditions are output to indicate the beginning and the end of a serial transfer. In Master receive mode the rst byte transmitted contains the slave address of the transmitting device (7 bits) and the R/W bit. In this case the R/W bit will be logic '1'. Thus the rst byte transmitted is a 7-bit slave address followed by a '1' to indicate receive bit. Serial data is received via SDA while SCL outputs the serial clock. Serial data is received 8 bits at a time. After each byte is received, an acknowledge bit is transmitted. START and STOP conditions indicate the beginning and end of transmission. The baud rate generator used for SPI mode operation is now used to set the SCL clock frequency for either 100 kHz, 400 kHz, or 1 MHz I2C operation. The baud rate generator reload value is contained in the lower 7 bits of the SSPADD register. The baud rate generator will automatically begin counting on a write to the SSPBUF. Once the given operation is complete (i.e. transmission of the last data bit is followed by ACK) the internal clock will automatically stop counting and the SCL pin will remain in its last state A typical transmit sequence would go as follows: Note: The MSSP Module, when congured in I2C Master Mode, does not allow queueing of events. For instance: The user is not allowed to initiate a start condition, and immediately write the SSPBUF register to initiate transmission before the START condition is complete. In this case the SSPBUF will not be written to, and the WCOL bit will be set, indicating that a write to the SSPBUF did not occur. a) b) The user generates a Start Condition by setting the START enable bit (SEN) in SSPCON2. SSPIF is set. The module will wait the required start time before any other operation takes place. The user loads the SSPBUF with address to transmit. Address is shifted out the SDA pin until all 8 bits are transmitted. The MSSP Module shifts in the ACK bit from the slave device, and writes its value into the SSPCON2 register ( SSPCON2<6>). The module generates an interrupt at the end of the ninth clock cycle by setting SSPIF. The user loads the SSPBUF with eight bits of data. DATA is shifted out the SDA pin until all 8 bits are transmitted.
9.2.7
Master Mode is enabled by setting and clearing the appropriate SSPM bits in SSPCON and by setting the SSPEN bit. Once master mode is enabled, the user has six options. - Assert a start condition on SDA and SCL. - Assert a Repeated Start condition on SDA and SCL. - Write to the SSPBUF register initiating transmission of data/address. - Generate a stop condition on SDA and SCL. - Congure the I2C port to receive data. - Generate an Acknowledge condition at the end of a received byte of data.
c) d) e)
f) g) h)
DS30292A-page 80
PIC16F87X
i) The MSSP Module shifts in the ACK bit from the slave device, and writes its value into the SSPCON2 register ( SSPCON2<6>). The MSSP module generates an interrupt at the end of the ninth clock cycle by setting the SSPIF bit. The user generates a STOP condition by setting the STOP enable bit PEN in SSPCON2. Interrupt is generated once the STOP condition is complete. BAUD RATE GENERATOR In I2C master mode, the BRG is reloaded automatically. If Clock Arbitration is taking place for instance, the BRG will be reloaded when the SCL pin is sampled high (Figure 9-19).
j)
k) l)
9.2.8
Reload Control
Reload
In I2C master mode, the reload value for the BRG is located in the lower 7 bits of the SSPADD register (Figure 9-18). When the BRG is loaded with this value, the BRG counts down to 0 and stops until another reload has TACKEN place. The BRG count is decremented twice per instruction cycle (TCY), on the Q2 and Q4 clock.
Fosc/4
SCL de-asserted but slave holds SCL low (clock arbitration) SCL
BRG decrements (on Q2 and Q4 cycles) BRG value 03h 02h 01h 00h (hold off) 03h 02h
SCL is sampled high, reload takes place, and BRG starts its count. BRG reload
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 81
PIC16F87X
9.2.9 I2C MASTER MODE START CONDITION TIMING by hardware, the baud rate generator is suspended leaving the SDA line held low, and the START condition is complete. Note: If at the beginning of START condition the SDA and SCL pins are already sampled low, or if during the START condition the SCL line is sampled low before the SDA line is driven low, a bus collision occurs, the Bus Collision Interrupt Flag (BCLIF) is set, the START condition is aborted, and the I2C module is reset into its IDLE state. WCOL STATUS FLAG
To initiate a START condition the user sets the start condition enable bit, SEN (SSPCON2<0>). If the SDA and SCL pins are sampled high, the baud rate generator is re-loaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0>, and starts its count. If SCL and SDA are both sampled high when the baud rate generator times out (TBRG), the SDA pin is driven low. The action of the SDA being driven low while SCL is high is the START condition, and causes the S bit (SSPSTAT<3>) to be set. Following this, the baud rate generator is reloaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0> and resumes its count. When the baud rate generator times out (TBRG) the SEN bit (SSPCON2<0>) will be automatically cleared
9.2.9.5
If the user writes the SSPBUF when an START sequence is in progress, then WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesnt occur). Note: Because queueing of events is not allowed, writing to the lower 5 bits of SSPCON2 is disabled until the START condition is complete.
TBRG
SCL
DS30292A-page 82
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-21: START CONDITION FLOWCHART
Idle Mode
SEN (SSPCON2<0> = 1)
No
No
Yes SCL= 0?
No SDA = 0?
No
BRG Rollover?
Yes
Yes
Reset BRG
No
SCL = 0?
No
BRG rollover?
Yes
Yes
Reset BRG Force SCL = 0, Start Condition Done, Clear SEN and set SSPIF
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 83
PIC16F87X
9.2.10 I2C MASTER MODE REPEATED START CONDITION TIMING dition is detected on the SDA and SCL pins, the S bit (SSPSTAT<3>) will be set. The SSPIF bit will not be set until the baud rate generator has timed-out. Note 1: If RSEN is programmed while any other event is in progress, it will not take effect. Note 2: A bus collision during the Repeated Start condition occurs if: SDA is sampled low when SCL goes from low to high. SCL goes low before SDA is asserted low. This may indicate that another master is attempting to transmit a data "1". Immediately following the SSPIF bit getting set, the user may write the SSPBUF with the 7-bit address in 7-bit mode, or the default rst address in 10-bit mode. After the rst eight bits are transmitted and an ACK is received, the user may then transmit an additional eight bits of address (10-bit mode) or eight bits of data (7-bit mode). 9.2.10.6 WCOL STATUS FLAG
A Repeated Start condition occurs when the RSEN bit (SSPCON2<1>) is programmed high and the I2C module is in the idle state. When the RSEN bit is set, the SCL pin is asserted low. When the SCL pin is sampled low, the baud rate generator is loaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0>, and begins counting. The SDA pin is released (brought high) for one baud rate generator count (TBRG). When the baud rate generator times out, if SDA is sampled high, the SCL pin will be de-asserted (brought high). When SCL is sampled high the baud rate generator is re-loaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0> and begins counting. SDA and SCL must be sampled high for one TBRG. This action is then followed by assertion of the SDA pin (SDA is low) for one TBRG while SCL is high. Following this, the RSEN bit in the SSPCON2 register will be automatically cleared, and the baud rate generator is not reloaded, leaving the SDA pin held low. As soon as a start con-
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a Repeated Start sequence is in progress, then WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesnt occur). Note: Because queueing of events is not allowed, writing of the lower 5 bits of SSPCON2 is disabled until the Repeated Start condition is complete.
TBRG
SCL
DS30292A-page 84
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-23: REPEATED START CONDITION FLOWCHART (PAGE 1)
Start B
Idle Mode, SSPEN = 1, SSPCON<3:0> = 1000
RSEN = 1
Force SCL = 0
No SCL = 0?
BRG rollover?
No
Yes
Release SCL
Yes
No SDA = 1?
Yes
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 85
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-24: REPEATED START CONDITION FLOWCHART (PAGE 2)
B C
Yes No No SCL = 1? SDA = 0? Yes Reset BRG Force SDA = 0, Load BRG with SSPADD<6:0> No BRG rollover? Yes
Set S
No
SCL = '0'?
No
BRG rollover?
Yes
Yes Force SCL = 0, Repeated Start condition done, Clear RSEN, Set SSPIF.
Reset BRG
DS30292A-page 86
PIC16F87X
9.2.11 I2C MASTER MODE TRANSMISSION 9.2.11.7 BF STATUS FLAG Transmission of a data byte, a 7-bit address, or either half of a 10-bit address is accomplished by simply writing a value to SSPBUF register. This action will set the buffer full ag (BF) and allow the baud rate generator to begin counting and start the next transmission. Each bit of address/data will be shifted out onto the SDA pin after the falling edge of SCL is asserted (see data hold time spec). SCL is held low for one baud rate generator roll over count (TBRG). Data should be valid before SCL is released high (see Data setup time spec). When the SCL pin is released high, it is held that way for TBRG, the data on the SDA pin must remain stable for that duration and some hold time after the next falling edge of SCL. After the eighth bit is shifted out (the falling edge of the eighth clock), the BF ag is cleared and the master releases SDA allowing the slave device being addressed to respond with an ACK bit during the ninth bit time, if an address match occurs or if data was received properly. The status of ACK is read into the ACKDT on the falling edge of the ninth clock. If the master receives an acknowledge, the acknowledge status bit (ACKSTAT) is cleared. If not, the bit is set. After the ninth clock the SSPIF is set, and the master clock (baud rate generator) is suspended until the next data byte is loaded into the SSPBUF leaving SCL low and SDA unchanged (Figure 9-26). After the write to the SSPBUF, each bit of address will be shifted out on the falling edge of SCL until all seven address bits and the R/W bit are completed. On the falling edge of the eighth clock the master will de-assert the SDA pin allowing the slave to respond with an acknowledge. On the falling edge of the ninth clock the master will sample the SDA pin to see if the address was recognized by a slave. The status of the ACK bit is loaded into the ACKSTAT status bit (SSPCON2<6>). Following the falling edge of the ninth clock transmission of the address, the SSPIF is set, the BF ag is cleared, and the baud rate generator is turned off until another write to the SSPBUF takes place, holding SCL low and allowing SDA to oat. In transmit mode, the BF bit (SSPSTAT<0>) is set when the CPU writes to SSPBUF and is cleared when all 8 bits are shifted out. 9.2.11.8 WCOL STATUS FLAG
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a transmit is already in progress (i.e. SSPSR is still shifting out a data byte), then WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesnt occur). WCOL must be cleared in software. 9.2.11.9 ACKSTAT STATUS FLAG
In transmit mode, the ACKSTAT bit (SSPCON2<6>) is cleared when the slave has sent an acknowledge (ACK = 0), and is set when the slave does not acknowledge (ACK = 1). A slave sends an acknowledge when it has recognized its address (including a general call), or when the slave has properly received its data.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 87
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-25: MASTER TRANSMIT FLOWCHART
Idle Mode
Write SSPBUF
Num_Clocks = 0, BF = 1
Force SCL = 0
Num_Clocks = 8? No Load BRG with SSPADD<6:0>, start BRG count, SDA = Current Data bit
Yes
BRG rollover?
No
BRG rollover?
No
Yes Yes Stop BRG, Force SCL = 1 Force SCL = 1, Stop BRG
(Clock Arbitration)
SCL = 1?
No
Yes Yes Read SDA and place into ACKSTAT bit (SSPCON2<6>) No Bus collision detected Set BCLIF, hold prescale off, Clear XMIT enable
DS30292A-page 88
Write SSPCON2<0> SEN = 1 START condition begins From slave clear ACKSTAT bit SSPCON2<6> R/W = 0 A1 ACK = 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 Transmitting Data or Second Half of 10-bit Address D1 D0 SEN = 0 Transmit Address to Slave SDA A7 SSPBUF written with 7 bit address and R/W start transmit SCL S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 SCL held low while CPU responds to SSPIF 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
DS30292A-page 89
PIC16F87X
9.2.12 I2C MASTER MODE RECEPTION Master mode reception is enabled by programming the receive enable bit, RCEN (SSPCON2<3>). Note: The SSP Module must be in an IDLE STATE before the RCEN bit is set, or the RCEN bit will be disregarded.
The baud rate generator begins counting, and on each rollover, the state of the SCL pin changes (high to low/ low to high), and data is shifted into the SSPSR. After the falling edge of the eighth clock, the receive enable ag is automatically cleared, the contents of the SSPSR are loaded into the SSPBUF, the BF ag is set, the SSPIF is set, and the baud rate generator is suspended from counting, holding SCL low. The SSP is now in IDLE state, awaiting the next command. When the buffer is read by the CPU, the BF ag is automatically cleared. The user can then send an acknowledge bit at the end of reception, by setting the acknowledge sequence enable bit, ACKEN (SSPCON2<4>). 9.2.12.10 BF STATUS FLAG In receive operation, BF is set when an address or data byte is loaded into SSPBUF from SSPSR. It is cleared when SSPBUF is read. 9.2.12.11 SSPOV STATUS FLAG In receive operation, SSPOV is set when 8 bits are received into the SSPSR, and the BF ag is already set from a previous reception. 9.2.12.12 WCOL STATUS FLAG If the user writes the SSPBUF when a receive is already in progress (i.e. SSPSR is still shifting in a data byte), then WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesnt occur).
DS30292A-page 90
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-27: MASTER RECEIVER FLOWCHART
Idle mode RCEN = 1
No
No
SCL = 0?
No
Yes
Num_Clocks = Num_Clocks + 1
No Num_Clocks = 8? Yes Force SCL = 0, Set SSPIF, Set BF. Move contents of SSPSR into SSPBUF, Clear RCEN.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 91
DS30292A-page 92
Write to SSPCON2<4> to start acknowledge sequence SDA = ACKDT (SSPCON2<5>) = 0 Master congured as a receiver by programming SSPCON2<3>, (RCEN = 1) ACK from Slave R/W = 1 Receiving Data from Slave ACK Receiving Data from Slave RCEN cleared automatically ACK RCEN = 1 start next receive RCEN cleared automatically ACK from Master SDA = ACKDT = 0 Set ACKEN start acknowledge sequence SDA = ACKDT = 1 PEN bit = 1 written here
PIC16F87X
SDA D0
A7 A1 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1
A6 A5 A4 A3 A2
D0
ACK
SCL
S
Set SSPIF interrupt at end of receive
1 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5
3 4 6 8 6 7 8 9
7 9
P
Set SSPIF interrupt at end of acknowledge sequence
SSPIF
Cleared in software Cleared in software
Set SSPIF interrupt at end of acknowledge sequence Cleared in software Cleared in software
Cleared in software
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
Last bit is shifted into SSPSR and contents are unloaded into SSPBUF
SSPOV
SSPOV is set because SSPBUF is still full
ACKEN
PIC16F87X
9.2.13 ACKNOWLEDGE SEQUENCE TIMING An acknowledge sequence is enabled by setting the acknowledge sequence enable bit, ACKEN (SSPCON2<4>). When this bit is set, the SCL pin is pulled low and the contents of the acknowledge data bit is presented on the SDA pin. If the user wishes to generate an acknowledge, then the ACKDT bit should be cleared. If not, the user should set the ACKDT bit before starting an acknowledge sequence. The baud rate generator then counts for one rollover period (TBRG), and the SCL pin is de-asserted (pulled high). When the SCL pin is sampled high (clock arbitration), the baud rate generator counts for TBRG . The SCL pin is then pulled low. Following this, the ACKEN bit is automatically cleared, the baud rate generator is turned off, and the SSP module then goes into IDLE mode. (Figure 9-29) 9.2.13.13 WCOL STATUS FLAG If the user writes the SSPBUF when an acknowledege sequence is in progress, then WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesnt occur).
Tbrg
SCL
SSPIF
Cleared in software
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 93
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-30: ACKNOWLEDGE FLOWCHART
Idle mode
Set ACKEN
Force SCL = 0 BRG rollover? No No SCL = 0? Yes Yes Drive ACKDT bit (SSPCON2<5>) onto SDA pin, Load BRG with SSPADD<6:0>, start count. SCL = 0? Reset BRG Force SCL = 0, Clear ACKEN, Set SSPIF Yes
No
No ACKDT = 1?
No (Clock Arbitration)
Bus collision detected, Set BCLIF, Release SCL, Clear ACKEN SCL = 1?
DS30292A-page 94
PIC16F87X
9.2.14 STOP CONDITION TIMING A stop bit is asserted on the SDA pin at the end of a receive/transmit by setting the Stop Sequence Enable bit PEN (SSPCON2<2>). At the end of a receive/transmit the SCL line is held low after the falling edge of the ninth clock. When the PEN bit is set, the master will assert the SDA line low . When the SDA line is sampled low, the baud rate generator is reloaded and counts down to 0. When the baud rate generator times out, the SCL pin will be brought high, and one TBRG (baud rate generator rollover count) later, the SDA pin will be de-asserted. When the SDA pin is sampled high while SCL is high, the P bit (SSPSTAT<4>) is set. A TBRG later the PEN bit is cleared and the SSPIF bit is set (Figure 9-31). Whenever the rmware decides to take control of the bus, it will rst determine if the bus is busy by checking the S and P bits in the SSPSTAT register. If the bus is busy, then the CPU can be interrupted (notied) when a Stop bit is detected (i.e. bus is free). 9.2.14.14 WCOL STATUS FLAG If the user writes the SSPBUF when a STOP sequence is in progress, then WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesnt occur).
Write to SSPCON2 Set PEN Falling edge of 9th clock SCL TBRG
SCL = 1 for TBRG, followed by SDA = 1 for TBRG after SDA sampled high. P bit (SSPSTAT<4>) is set PEN bit (SSPCON2<2>) is cleared by hardware and the SSPIF bit is set
SDA
ACK
P
TBRG TBRG TBRG SCL brought high after TBRG SDA asserted low before rising edge of clock to setup stop condition.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 95
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-32: STOP CONDITION FLOWCHART
Idle Mode, SSPEN = 1, SSPCON<3:0> = 1000
PEN = 1
Start BRG
No
No SDA = 0?
BRG rollover?
Yes SDA going from 0 to 1 while SCL = 1 Set SSPIF, Stop Condition done PEN cleared.
Yes
DS30292A-page 96
PIC16F87X
9.2.15 CLOCK ARBITRATION 9.2.16 SLEEP OPERATION Clock arbitration occurs when the master, during any receive, transmit, or repeated start/stop condition, deasserts the SCL pin (SCL allowed to oat high). When the SCL pin is allowed to oat high, the baud rate generator (BRG) is suspended from counting until the SCL pin is actually sampled high. When the SCL pin is sampled high, the baud rate generator is reloaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0> and begins counting. This ensures that the SCL high time will always be at least one BRG rollover count in the event that the clock is held low by an external device (Figure 9-33). While in sleep mode, the I2C module can receive addresses or data, and when an address match or complete byte transfer occurs wake the processor from sleep ( if the SSP interrupt is enabled). 9.2.17 EFFECTS OF A RESET
A reset disables the SSP module and terminates the current transfer.
BRG overow occurs, Release SCL, Slave device holds SCL low.
SCL SCL line sampled once every machine cycle (Tosc 4). Hold off BRG until SCL is sampled high.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 97
PIC16F87X
9.2.18 MULTI -MASTER COMMUNICATION, BUS COLLISION, AND BUS ARBITRATION If a START, Repeated Start, STOP, or Acknowledge condition was in progress when the bus collision occurred, the condition is aborted, the SDA and SCL lines are de-asserted, and the respective control bits in the SSPCON2 register are cleared. When the user services the bus collision interrupt service routine, and if the I2C bus is free, the user can resume communication by asserting a START condition. The Master will continue to monitor the SDA and SCL pins, and if a STOP condition occurs, the SSPIF bit will be set. A write to the SSPBUF will start the transmission of data at the rst data bit, regardless of where the transmitter left off when bus collision occurred. In multi-master mode, the interrupt generation on the detection of start and stop conditions allows the determination of when the bus is free. Control of the I2C bus can be TACKEN when the P bit is set in the SSPSTAT register, or the bus is idle and the S and P bits are cleared.
Multi-Master mode support is achieved by bus arbitration. When the master outputs address/data bits onto the SDA pin, arbitration takes place when the master outputs a '1' on SDA by letting SDA oat high and another master asserts a '0'. When the SCL pin oats high, data should be stable. If the expected data on SDA is a '1' and the data sampled on the SDA pin = '0', then a bus collision has TACKEN place. The master will set the Bus Collision Interrupt Flag, BCLIF and reset the I2C port to its IDLE state. (Figure 9-34). If a transmit was in progress when the bus collision occurred, the transmission is halted, the BF ag is cleared, the SDA and SCL lines are de-asserted, and the SSPBUF can be written to. When the user services the bus collision interrupt service routine, and if the I2C bus is free, the user can resume communication by asserting a START condition.
SCL
BCLIF
DS30292A-page 98
PIC16F87X
9.2.18.15 BUS COLLISION DURING A START CONDITION During a START condition, a bus collision occurs if: a) b) SDA or SCL are sampled low at the beginning of the START condition (Figure 9-35). SCL is sampled low before SDA is asserted low. (Figure 9-36). while SDA is high, a bus collision occurs, because it is assumed that another master is attempting to drive a data '1' during the START condition. If the SDA pin is sampled low during this count, the BRG is reset and the SDA line is asserted early (Figure 9-37). If however a '1' is sampled on the SDA pin, the SDA pin is asserted low at the end of the BRG count. The baud rate generator is then reloaded and counts down to 0, and during this time, if the SCL pins is sampled as '0', a bus collision does not occur. At the end of the BRG count the SCL pin is asserted low. Note: The reason that bus collision is not a factor during a START condition is that no two bus masters can assert a START condition at the exact same time. Therefore, one master will always assert SDA before the other. This condition does not cause a bus collision because the two masters must be allowed to arbitrate the rst address following the START condition, and if the address is the same, arbitration must be allowed to continue into the data portion, REPEATED START, or STOP conditions.
During a START condition both the SDA and the SCL pins are monitored. If: the SDA pin is already low or the SCL pin is already low, then: the START condition is aborted, and the BCLIF ag is set, and the SSP module is reset to its IDLE state (Figure 9-35). The START condition begins with the SDA and SCL pins de-asserted. When the SDA pin is sampled high, the baud rate generator is loaded from SSPADD<6:0> and counts down to 0. If the SCL pin is sampled low
SDA
SCL
Set SEN, enable start condition if SDA = 1, SCL=1 SEN cleared automatically because of bus collision. SSP module reset into idle state.
SEN
SDA sampled low before START condition. Set BCLIF. S bit and SSPIF set because SDA = 0, SCL = 1 SSPIF and BCLIF are cleared in software.
BCLIF
SSPIF
SSPIF and BCLIF are cleared in software.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 99
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 9-36: BUS COLLISION DURING START CONDITION (SCL = 0)
SDA = 0, SCL = 1
TBRG TBRG
SDA
Set SEN, enable start sequence if SDA = 1, SCL = 1 SCL = 0 before SDA = 0, Bus collision occurs, Set BCLIF. SCL = 0 before BRG time out, Bus collision occurs, Set BCLIF.
SCL SEN
BCLIF
Interrupts cleared in software.
S SSPIF
'0' '0'
'0' '0'
FIGURE 9-37: BRG RESET DUE TO SDA COLLISION DURING START CONDITION
SDA = 0, SCL = 1 Set S
Less than TBRG TBRG
Set SSPIF
SDA
SDA pulled low by other master. Reset BRG and assert SDA
S
SCL pulled low after BRG Timeout
SSPIF
SDA = 0, SCL = 1 Set SSPIF Interrupts cleared in software.
DS30292A-page 100
PIC16F87X
9.2.18.16 BUS COLLISION DURING A REPEATED START CONDITION During a Repeated Start condition, a bus collision occurs if: a) b) A low level is sampled on SDA when SCL goes from low level to high level. SCL goes low before SDA is asserted low, indicating that another master is attempting to transmit a data 1. however SDA is sampled high then the BRG is reloaded and begins counting. If SDA goes from high to low before the BRG times out, no bus collision occurs, because no two masters can assert SDA at exactly the same time. If, however, SCL goes from high to low before the BRG times out and SDA has not already been asserted, then a bus collision occurs. In this case, another master is attempting to transmit a data 1 during the Repeated Start condition. If at the end of the BRG time out both SCL and SDA are still high, the SDA pin is driven low, the BRG is reloaded, and begins counting. At the end of the count, regardless of the status of the SCL pin, the SCL pin is driven low and the Repeated Start condition is complete (Figure 9-38).
When the user de-asserts SDA and the pin is allowed to oat high, the BRG is loaded with SSPADD<6:0>, and counts down to 0. The SCL pin is then deasserted, and when sampled high, the SDA pin is sampled. If SDA is low, a bus collision has occurred (i.e. another master is attempting to transmit a data 0). If
SCL
Sample SDA when SCL goes high. If SDA = 0, set BCLIF and release SDA and SCL
RSEN BCLIF
Cleared in software '0' '0'
S SSPIF
'0' '0'
TBRG
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 101
PIC16F87X
9.2.18.17 BUS COLLISION DURING A STOP CONDITION Bus collision occurs during a STOP condition if: a) After the SDA pin has been de-asserted and allowed to oat high, SDA is sampled low after the BRG has timed out. After the SCL pin is de-asserted, SCL is sampled low before SDA goes high. The STOP condition begins with SDA asserted low. When SDA is sampled low, the SCL pin is allow to oat. When the pin is sampled high (clock arbitration), the baud rate generator is loaded with SSPADD<6:0> and counts down to 0. After the BRG times out SDA is sampled. If SDA is sampled low, a bus collision has occurred. This is due to another master attempting to drive a data '0'. If the SCL pin is sampled low before SDA is allowed to oat high, a bus collision occurs. This is another case of another master attempting to drive a data '0' (Figure 9-40).
b)
TBRG
TBRG
FIGURE 9-41:
SDA
Assert SDA SCL goes low before SDA goes high Set BCLIF
DS30292A-page 102
PIC16F87X
9.3 Connection Considerations for I2C Bus
example, with a supply voltage of VDD = 5V+10% and VOL max = 0.4V at 3 mA, Rp min = (5.5-0.4)/0.003 = 1.7 k. VDD as a function of Rp is shown in Figure 9-42. The desired noise margin of 0.1VDD for the low level limits the maximum value of Rs. Series resistors are optional and used to improve ESD susceptibility. The bus capacitance is the total capacitance of wire, connections, and pins. This capacitance limits the maximum value of Rp due to the specied rise time (Figure 9-42). The SMP bit is the slew rate control enabled bit. This bit is in the SSPSTAT register, and controls the slew rate of the I/O pins when in I2C mode (master or slave).
For standard-mode I2C bus devices, the values of resistors Rp and Rs in Figure 9-42 depends on the following parameters Supply voltage Bus capacitance Number of connected devices (input current + leakage current). The supply voltage limits the minimum value of resistor Rp due to the specied minimum sink current of 3 mA at VOL max = 0.4V for the specied output stages. For
Rp
Rp
DEVICE
Rs
Rs
SDA SCL NOTE: I2C devices with input levels related to VDD must have one common supply line to which the pull up resistor is also connected.
Cb=10 - 400 pF
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 103
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 104
PIC16F87X
10.0 ADDRESSABLE UNIVERSAL SYNCHRONOUS ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER TRANSMITTER (USART)
The USART can be congured in the following modes: Asynchronous (full duplex) Synchronous - Master (half duplex) Synchronous - Slave (half duplex) Bit SPEN (RCSTA<7>), and bits TRISC<7:6>, have to be set in order to congure pins RC6/TX/CK and RC7/ RX/DT as the Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter. The USART module also has a multi-processor communication capability using 9-bit address detection.
The Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART) module is one of the two serial I/O modules. (USART is also known as a Serial Communications Interface or SCI). The USART can be congured as a full duplex asynchronous system that can communicate with peripheral devices such as CRT terminals and personal computers, or it can be congured as a half duplex synchronous system that can communicate with peripheral devices such as A/D or D/A integrated circuits, Serial EEPROMs etc.
FIGURE 10-1: TXSTA: TRANSMIT STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (ADDRESS 98h)
R/W-0 CSRC bit7 R/W-0 TX9 R/W-0 TXEN R/W-0 SYNC U-0 R/W-0 BRGH R-1 TRMT R/W-0 TX9D bit0
R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
CSRC: Clock Source Select bit Asynchronous mode Dont care Synchronous mode 1 = Master mode (Clock generated internally from BRG) 0 = Slave mode (Clock from external source)
bit 6:
TX9: 9-bit Transmit Enable bit 1 = Selects 9-bit transmission 0 = Selects 8-bit transmission TXEN: Transmit Enable bit 1 = Transmit enabled 0 = Transmit disabled Note: SREN/CREN overrides TXEN in SYNC mode. SYNC: USART Mode Select bit 1 = Synchronous mode 0 = Asynchronous mode Unimplemented: Read as '0' BRGH: High Baud Rate Select bit Asynchronous mode 1 = High speed 0 = Low speed Synchronous mode Unused in this mode
bit 5:
bit 4:
bit 3: bit 2:
bit 1:
TRMT: Transmit Shift Register Status bit 1 = TSR empty 0 = TSR full TX9D: 9th bit of transmit data. Can be parity bit.
bit 0:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 105
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 10-2: RCSTA: RECEIVE STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (ADDRESS 18h)
R/W-0 SPEN bit7 R/W-0 RX9 R/W-0 SREN R/W-0 CREN R/W-0 ADDEN R-0 FERR R-0 OERR R-x RX9D bit0
R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n =Value at POR reset
bit 7:
SPEN: Serial Port Enable bit 1 = Serial port enabled (Congures RC7/RX/DT and RC6/TX/CK pins as serial port pins) 0 = Serial port disabled RX9: 9-bit Receive Enable bit 1 = Selects 9-bit reception 0 = Selects 8-bit reception SREN: Single Receive Enable bit Asynchronous mode Dont care Synchronous mode - master 1 = Enables single receive 0 = Disables single receive This bit is cleared after reception is complete. Synchronous mode - slave Unused in this mode
bit 6:
bit 5:
bit 4:
CREN: Continuous Receive Enable bit Asynchronous mode 1 = Enables continuous receive 0 = Disables continuous receive Synchronous mode 1 = Enables continuous receive until enable bit CREN is cleared (CREN overrides SREN) 0 = Disables continuous receive
bit 3:
ADDEN: Address Detect Enable bit Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 1) 1 = Enables address detection, enable interrupt and load of the receive burffer when RSR<8> is set 0 = Disables address detection, all bytes are received, and ninth bit can be used as parity bit FERR: Framing Error bit 1 = Framing error (Can be updated by reading RCREG register and receive next valid byte) 0 = No framing error OERR: Overrun Error bit 1 = Overrun error (Can be cleared by clearing bit CREN) 0 = No overrun error RX9D: 9th bit of received data (Can be parity bit)
bit 2:
bit 1:
bit 0:
DS30292A-page 106
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
10.1 USART Baud Rate Generator (BRG)
The BRG supports both the Asynchronous and Synchronous modes of the USART. It is a dedicated 8-bit baud rate generator. The SPBRG register controls the period of a free running 8-bit timer. In asynchronous mode bit BRGH (TXSTA<2>) also controls the baud rate. In synchronous mode bit BRGH is ignored. Table 10-1 shows the formula for computation of the baud rate for different USART modes which only apply in master mode (internal clock). Given the desired baud rate and Fosc, the nearest integer value for the SPBRG register can be calculated using the formula in Table 10-1. From this, the error in baud rate can be determined. Example 10-1 shows the calculation of the baud rate error for the following conditions: FOSC = 16 MHz Desired Baud Rate = 9600 BRGH = 0 SYNC = 0
Calculated Baud Rate=16000000 / (64 (25 + 1)) = Error = = = 9615 (Calculated Baud Rate - Desired Baud Rate) Desired Baud Rate (9615 - 9600) / 9600 0.16%
It may be advantageous to use the high baud rate (BRGH = 1) even for slower baud clocks. This is because the FOSC/(16(X + 1)) equation can reduce the baud rate error in some cases. Writing a new value to the SPBRG register, causes the BRG timer to be reset (or cleared), this ensures the BRG does not wait for a timer overow before outputting the new baud rate. 10.1.1 SAMPLING
The data on the RC7/RX/DT pin is sampled three times by a majority detect circuit to determine if a high or a low level is present at the RX pin.
TABLE 10-1
SYNC
0 1
(Asynchronous) Baud Rate = FOSC/(64(X+1)) (Synchronous) Baud Rate = FOSC/(4(X+1)) X = value in SPBRG (0 to 255)
TABLE 10-2
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TXSTA RCSTA
CSRC SPEN
TX9 RX9
TXEN
SYNC
ADDEN
BRGH FERR
TRMT
SREN CREN
Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used by the BRG.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 107
PIC16F87X
TABLE 10-3
BAUD RATE (K) 0.3 1.2 2.4 9.6 19.2 76.8 96 300 500 HIGH LOW
FOSC = 20 MHz
KBAUD NA NA NA NA 19.53 76.92 96.15 294.1 500 5000 19.53
3.579545 MHz
SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG KBAUD % value KBAUD % value KBAUD % value KBAUD % value KBAUD % value ERROR (decimal) ERROR (decimal) ERROR (decimal) ERROR (decimal) ERROR (decimal) NA NA NA 9.6 19.2 79.2 97.48 316.8 NA 1267 4.950 0 0 +3.13 +1.54 +5.60 131 65 15 12 3 0 255 NA NA NA 9.615 19.231 76.923 1000 NA NA 100 3.906 +0.16 +0.16 +0.16 +4.17 103 51 12 9 0 255 NA NA NA 9.622 19.04 74.57 99.43 298.3 NA 894.9 3.496 +0.23 -0.83 -2.90 +3.57 -0.57 92 46 11 8 2 0 255 NA 1.202 2.404 9.615 19.24 83.34 NA NA NA 250 0.9766 +0.16 +0.16 +0.16 +0.16 +8.51 207 103 25 12 2 0 255 0.303 1.170 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 8.192 0.032 +1.14 -2.48 26 6 0 255
TABLE 10-4
BAUD RATE (K) 0.3 1.2 2.4 9.6 19.2 76.8 96 300 500 HIGH LOW
FOSC = 20 MHz
KBAUD NA 1.221 2.404 9.469 19.53 78.13 104.2 312.5 NA 312.5 1.221
3.579545 MHz
SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG % value % value % value % value % value KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) 0.31 1.2 2.4 9.9 19.8 79.2 NA NA NA 79.2 0.3094 +3.13 0 0 +3.13 +3.13 +3.13 255 65 32 7 3 0 0 255 0.3005 1.202 2.404 NA NA NA NA NA NA 62.500 3.906 -0.17 +1.67 +1.67 207 51 25 0 255 0.301 1.190 2.432 9.322 18.64 NA NA NA NA 55.93 0.2185 +0.23 -0.83 +1.32 -2.90 -2.90 185 46 22 5 2 0 255 0.300 1.202 2.232 NA NA NA NA NA NA 15.63 0.0610 +0.16 +0.16 -6.99 51 12 6 0 255 0.256 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA 0.512 0.0020 -14.67 1 0 255
DS30292A-page 108
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 10-5
BAUD RATE (K) 9.6 19.2 38.4 57.6 115.2 250 625 1250 BAUD RATE (K) 9.6 19.2 38.4 57.6 115.2 250 625 1250
FOSC = 20 MHz
KBAUD 9.615 19.230 37.878 56.818 113.636 250 625 1250
4 MHz 3.579 MHz 1 MHz 32.768 kHz SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG SPBRG % value % value % value % value % value KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) KBAUD ERROR (decimal) 9.6 18.645 39.6 52.8 105.6 NA NA NA 0 -2.94 +3.12 -8.33 -8.33 32 16 7 5 2 NA 1.202 2.403 9.615 19.231 NA NA NA +0.17 +0.13 +0.16 +0.16 207 103 25 12 9.727 18.643 +1.32 -2.90 22 11 5 3 1 0 8.928 20.833 31.25 62.5 NA NA NA NA -6.99 +8.51 -18.61 +8.51 6 2 1 0 NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA -
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 109
PIC16F87X
10.2 USART Asynchronous Mode
In this mode, the USART uses standard nonreturn-tozero (NRZ) format (one start bit, eight or nine data bits and one stop bit). The most common data format is 8-bits. An on-chip dedicated 8-bit baud rate generator can be used to derive standard baud rate frequencies from the oscillator. The USART transmits and receives the LSb rst. The USARTs transmitter and receiver are functionally independent but use the same data format and baud rate. The baud rate generator produces a clock either x16 or x64 of the bit shift rate, depending on bit BRGH (TXSTA<2>). Parity is not supported by the hardware, but can be implemented in software (and stored as the ninth data bit). Asynchronous mode is stopped during SLEEP. Asynchronous mode is selected by clearing bit SYNC (TXSTA<4>). The USART Asynchronous module consists of the following important elements: Baud Rate Generator Sampling Circuit Asynchronous Transmitter Asynchronous Receiver USART ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMITTER (occurs in one TCY), the TXREG register is empty and ag bit TXIF (PIR1<4>) is set. This interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit TXIE ( PIE1<4>). Flag bit TXIF will be set regardless of the state of enable bit TXIE and cannot be cleared in software. It will reset only when new data is loaded into the TXREG register. While ag bit TXIF indicated the status of the TXREG register, another bit TRMT (TXSTA<1>) shows the status of the TSR register. Status bit TRMT is a read only bit which is set when the TSR register is empty. No interrupt logic is tied to this bit, so the user has to poll this bit in order to determine if the TSR register is empty. Note 1: The TSR register is not mapped in data memory so it is not available to the user. Note 2: Flag bit TXIF is set when enable bit TXEN is set. Steps to follow when setting up an Asynchronous Transmission: 1. Initialize the SPBRG register for the appropriate baud rate. If a high speed baud rate is desired, set bit BRGH. (Section 10.1) Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN. If interrupts are desired, then set enable bit TXIE. If 9-bit transmission is desired, then set transmit bit TX9. Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN, which will also set bit TXIF. If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit should be loaded in bit TX9D. Load data to the TXREG register (starts transmission).
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
10.2.1
The USART transmitter block diagram is shown in Figure 10-3. The heart of the transmitter is the transmit (serial) shift register (TSR). The shift register obtains its data from the read/write transmit buffer, TXREG. The TXREG register is loaded with data in software. The TSR register is not loaded until the STOP bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As soon as the STOP bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded with new data from the TXREG register (if available). Once the TXREG register transfers the data to the TSR register
DS30292A-page 110
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 10-4: ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Write to TXREG BRG output (shift clock) RC6/TX/CK (pin) TXIF bit (Transmit buffer reg. empty ag) Word 1
Start Bit
Bit 0
Bit 1 WORD 1
Bit 7/8
Stop Bit
Start Bit
Bit 0
Bit 1 WORD 1
Bit 7/8
Stop Bit
Bit 0
TABLE 10-6
Address Name 0Ch 18h 19h PIR1 RCSTA
8Ch PIE1 ADIE RCIE TXIE SSPIE CCP1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 -010 0000 -010 98h TXSTA CSRC TX9 TXEN SYNC BRGH TRMT TX9D 99h SPBRG Baud Rate Generator Register 0000 0000 0000 0000 Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented locations read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for Asynchronous Transmission. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 111
PIC16F87X
10.2.2 USART ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER 10.2.3 The receiver block diagram is shown in Figure 10-6. The data is received on the RC7/RX/DT pin and drives the data recovery block. The data recovery block is actually a high speed shifter operating at x16 times the baud rate, whereas the main receive serial shifter operates at the bit rate or at FOSC. The USART module has a special provision for multiprocessor communication. When the RX9 bit is set in the RCSTA register, 9-bits are received and the ninth bit is placed in the RX9D status bit of the RSTA register. The port can be programmed such that when the stop bit is received, the serial port interrupt will only be activated if the RX9D bit = 1. This feature is enabled by setting the ADDEN bit RCSTA<3> in the RCSTA register. This feature can be used in a multi-processor system as follows: A master processor intends to transmit a block of data to one of many slaves. It must rst send out an address byte that identies the target slave. An address byte is identied by the RX9D bit being a 1 (instead of a 0 for a data byte). If the ADDEN bit is set in the slaves RCSTA register, all data bytes will be ignored. However, if the ninth received bit is equal to a 1, indicating that the received byte is an address, the slave will be interrupted and the contents of the RSR register will be transferred into the receive buffer. This allows the slave to be interrupted only by addresses, so that the slave can examine the received byte to see if it is addressed. The addressed slave will then clear its ADDEN bit and prepare to receive data bytes from the master. When ADDEN is set, all data bytes are ignored. Following the STOP bit, the data will not be loaded into the receive buffer, and no interrupt will occur. If another byte is shifted into the RSR register, the previous data byte will be lost. The ADDEN bit will only take effect when the receiver is congured in 9-bit asynchronous mode. The receiver block diagram is shown in Figure 10-6. Once Asynchronous mode is selected, reception is enabled by setting bit CREN (RCSTA<4>). SETTING UP 9-BIT MODE WITH ADDRESS DETECT
Steps to follow when setting up an Asynchronous Reception with Address Detect Enabled: Initialize the SPBRG register for the appropriate baud rate. If a high speed baud rate is desired, set bit BRGH. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN. If interrupts are desired, then set enable bit RCIE. Set bit RX9 to enable 9-bit reception. Set ADDEN to enable address detect. Enable the reception by setting enable bit CREN. Flag bit RCIF will be set when reception is complete, and an interrupt will be generated if enable bit RCIE was set. Read the RCSTA register to get the ninth bit and determine if any error occurred during reception. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the RCREG register, to determine if the device is being addressed. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing enable bit CREN. If the device has been addressed, clear the ADDEN bit to allow data bytes and address bytes to be read into the receive buffer, and interrupt the CPU.
DS30292A-page 112
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 10-6: USART RECEIVE BLOCK DIAGRAM
x64 Baud Rate CLK CREN SPBRG 64 or 16 OERR FERR
RSR register 1
LSb 0 Start
Baud Rate Generator RC7/RX/DT Pin Buffer and Control Data Recovery
RX9
8 SPEN
RX9D
Load RSR Bit8 = 0, Data Byte Read Bit8 = 1, Address Byte WORD 1 RCREG
RCIF
Note: This timing diagram shows a data byte followed by an address byte. The data byte is not read into the RCREG (receive buffer) because ADDEN = 1.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 113
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 10-8: ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION WITH ADDRESS BYTE FIRST
RC7/RX/DT (pin) Start bit bit0 bit1 bit8 Stop bit Start bit bit0 bit8 Stop bit
Load RSR Bit8 = 1, Address Byte Read Bit8 = 0, Data Byte WORD 1 RCREG
RCIF
Note: This timing diagram shows an address byte followed by a data byte. The data byte is not read into the RCREG (receive buffer) because ADEN was not updated and still = 0.
TABLE 10-7
Address Name 0Ch 18h 1Ah 8Ch 98h 99h PIR1 RCSTA
CREN ADDEN
RCREG USART Receive Register PIE1 TXSTA SPBRG ADIE TX9 RCIE TXEN
Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented locations read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for Asynchronous Reception. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
DS30292A-page 114
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
10.3 USART Synchronous Master Mode
In Synchronous Master mode, the data is transmitted in a half-duplex manner i.e. transmission and reception do not occur at the same time. When transmitting data, the reception is inhibited and vice versa. Synchronous mode is entered by setting bit SYNC (TXSTA<4>). In addition enable bit SPEN (RCSTA<7>) is set in order to congure the RC6/TX/CK and RC7/RX/DT I/O pins to CK (clock) and DT (data) lines respectively. The Master mode indicates that the processor transmits the master clock on the CK line. The Master mode is entered by setting bit CSRC (TXSTA<7>). 10.3.1 USART SYNCHRONOUS MASTER TRANSMISSION enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit TXIE (PIE1<4>). Flag bit TXIF will be set regardless of the state of enable bit TXIE and cannot be cleared in software. It will reset only when new data is loaded into the TXREG register. While ag bit TXIF indicates the status of the TXREG register, another bit TRMT (TXSTA<1>) shows the status of the TSR register. TRMT is a read only bit which is set when the TSR is empty. No interrupt logic is tied to this bit, so the user has to poll this bit in order to determine if the TSR register is empty. The TSR is not mapped in data memory so it is not available to the user. Steps to follow when setting up a Synchronous Master Transmission: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Initialize the SPBRG register for the appropriate baud rate (Section 10.1). Enable the synchronous master serial port by setting bits SYNC, SPEN, and CSRC. If interrupts are desired, then set enable bit TXIE. If 9-bit transmission is desired, then set bit TX9. Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN. If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit should be loaded in bit TX9D. Start transmission by loading data to the TXREG register.
The USART transmitter block diagram is shown in Figure 10-3. The heart of the transmitter is the transmit (serial) shift register (TSR). The shift register obtains its data from the read/write transmit buffer register TXREG. The TXREG register is loaded with data in software. The TSR register is not loaded until the last bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As soon as the last bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded with new data from the TXREG (if available). Once the TXREG register transfers the data to the TSR register (occurs in one Tcycle), the TXREG is empty and interrupt bit, TXIF (PIR1<4>) is set. The interrupt can be
TABLE 10-8
Address 0Ch 18h 19h 8Ch 98h Name PIR1 RCSTA TXREG PIE1 TXSTA
CREN ADDEN
0000 0000 99h SPBRG Baud Rate Generator Register Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented, read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for Synchronous Master Transmission. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 115
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 10-9: SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Q1Q2 Q3Q4 Q1 Q2Q3 Q4Q1 Q2Q3 Q4Q1 Q2Q3 Q4Q1 Q2 Q3Q4 Q3Q4 Q1Q2 Q3Q4 Q1Q2 Q3Q4 Q1Q2 Q3 Q4Q1 Q2Q3 Q4Q1 Q2Q3 Q4Q1 Q2Q3 Q4
Bit 0
Bit 1 WORD 1
Bit 2
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1 WORD 2
Bit 7
Write word2
TXIF bit
(Interrupt flag) TRMT TRMT bit
TXEN bit
'1'
Note: Sync master mode; SPBRG = '0'. Continuous transmission of two 8-bit words.
'1'
TXIF bit
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
DS30292A-page 116
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
10.3.2 USART SYNCHRONOUS MASTER RECEPTION Ensure bits CREN and SREN are clear. If interrupts are desired, then set enable bit RCIE. 5. If 9-bit reception is desired, then set bit RX9. 6. If a single reception is required, set bit SREN. For continuous reception set bit CREN. 7. Interrupt ag bit RCIF will be set when reception is complete and an interrupt will be generated if enable bit RCIE was set. 8. Read the RCSTA register to get the ninth bit (if enabled) and determine if any error occurred during reception. 9. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the RCREG register. 10. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing bit CREN. 3. 4.
Once Synchronous mode is selected, reception is enabled by setting either enable bit SREN (RCSTA<5>) or enable bit CREN (RCSTA<4>). Data is sampled on the RC7/RX/DT pin on the falling edge of the clock. If enable bit SREN is set, then only a single word is received. If enable bit CREN is set, the reception is continuous until CREN is cleared. If both bits are set then CREN takes precedence. Steps to follow when setting up a Synchronous Master Reception: 1. 2. Initialize the SPBRG register for the appropriate baud rate. (Section 10.1) Enable the synchronous master serial port by setting bits SYNC, SPEN, and CSRC.
TABLE 10-9
Address Name 0Ch 18h 1Ah 8Ch 98h PIR1 RCSTA RCREG PIE1 TXSTA
0000 0000 99h SPBRG Baud Rate Generator Register Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for Synchronous Master Reception. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
RC7/RX/DT pin RC6/TX/CK pin Write to bit SREN SREN bit CREN bit '0' RCIF bit (interrupt) Read RXREG
bit0
bit1
bit2
bit3
bit4
bit5
bit6
bit7
'0'
Note: Timing diagram demonstrates SYNC master mode with bit SREN = '1' and bit BRGH = '0'.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 117
PIC16F87X
10.4 USART Synchronous Slave Mode
10.4.2 USART SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE RECEPTION Synchronous slave mode differs from the Master mode in the fact that the shift clock is supplied externally at the RC6/TX/CK pin (instead of being supplied internally in master mode). This allows the device to transfer or receive data while in SLEEP mode. Slave mode is entered by clearing bit CSRC (TXSTA<7>). 10.4.1 USART SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE TRANSMIT
The operation of the synchronous master and slave modes is identical except in the case of the SLEEP mode. Also, bit SREN is a don't care in slave mode. If receive is enabled, by setting bit CREN, prior to the SLEEP instruction, then a word may be received during SLEEP. On completely receiving the word, the RSR register will transfer the data to the RCREG register and if enable bit RCIE bit is set, the interrupt generated will wake the chip from SLEEP. If the global interrupt is enabled, the program will branch to the interrupt vector (0004h). Steps to follow when setting up a Synchronous Slave Reception: 1. Enable the synchronous master serial port by setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit CSRC. If interrupts are desired, then set enable bit RCIE. If 9-bit reception is desired, then set bit RX9. To enable reception, set enable bit CREN. Flag bit RCIF will be set when reception is complete and an interrupt will be generated, if enable bit RCIE was set. Read the RCSTA register to get the ninth bit (if enabled) and determine if any error occurred during reception. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the RCREG register. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing bit CREN.
The operation of the synchronous master and slave modes are identical except in the case of the SLEEP mode. If two words are written to the TXREG and then the SLEEP instruction is executed, the following will occur: a) b) c) d) The rst word will immediately transfer to the TSR register and transmit. The second word will remain in TXREG register. Flag bit TXIF will not be set. When the rst word has been shifted out of TSR, the TXREG register will transfer the second word to the TSR and ag bit TXIF will now be set. If enable bit TXIE is set, the interrupt will wake the chip from SLEEP and if the global interrupt is enabled, the program will branch to the interrupt vector (0004h).
2. 3. 4. 5.
e)
6.
Steps to follow when setting up a Synchronous Slave Transmission: 1. Enable the synchronous slave serial port by setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit CSRC. Clear bits CREN and SREN. If interrupts are desired, then set enable bit TXIE. If 9-bit transmission is desired, then set bit TX9. Enable the transmission by setting enable bit TXEN. If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit should be loaded in bit TX9D. Start transmission by loading data to the TXREG register.
7. 8.
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
DS30292A-page 118
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 10-10
Address Name 0Ch 18h 19h 8Ch 98h PIR1 RCSTA TXREG PIE1 TXSTA
0000 0000 99h SPBRG Baud Rate Generator Register Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for Synchronous Slave Transmission. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
TABLE 10-11
Address Name 0Ch 18h 1Ah 8Ch 98h PIR1 RCSTA RCRE G PIE1 TXSTA
99h SPBRG Baud Rate Generator Register Legend: x = unknown, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for Synchronous Slave Reception. Note 1: Bits PSPIE and PSPIF are reserved on the 28-pin devices, always maintain these bits clear.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 119
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 120
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
11.0 ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (A/D) MODULE
The A/D module has four registers. These registers are: A/D Result High Register (ADRESH) A/D Result Low Register (ADRESL) A/D Control Register0 (ADCON0) A/D Control Register1 (ADCON1)
The analog-to-digital (A/D) converter module has ve inputs for the 28-pin devices, and eight for the other devices. The analog input charges a sample and hold capacitor. The output of the sample and hold capacitor is the input into the converter. The converter then generates a digital result of this analog level via successive approximation. This A/D conversion, of the analog input signal, results in a corresponding 10-bit digital number. The A/D converter has a unique feature of being able to operate while the device is in SLEEP mode. To operate in sleep, the A/D clock must be derived from the A/Ds internal RC oscillator.
The ADCON0 register, shown in Figure 11-1, controls the operation of the A/D module. The ADCON1 register, shown in Figure 11-2, congures the functions of the port pins. The port pins can be congured as analog inputs (RA3 can also be the voltage reference) or as digital I/O.
R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n = Value at POR reset
bit 7-6: ADCS1:ADCS0: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits 00 = FOSC/2 01 = FOSC/8 10 = FOSC/32 11 = FRC (clock derived from an RC oscillation) bit 5-3: CHS2:CHS0: Analog Channel Select bits 000 = channel 0, (RA0/AN0) 001 = channel 1, (RA1/AN1) 010 = channel 2, (RA2/AN2) 011 = channel 3, (RA3/AN3) 100 = channel 4, (RA5/AN4) 101 = channel 5, (RE0/AN5)(1) 110 = channel 6, (RE1/AN6)(1) 111 = channel 7, (RE2/AN7)(1) bit 2: GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit If ADON = 1 1 = A/D conversion in progress (setting this bit starts the A/D conversion) 0 = A/D conversion not in progress (This bit is automatically cleared by hardware when the A/D conversion is complete) bit 1: bit 0: Unimplemented: Read as '0' ADON: A/D On bit 1 = A/D converter module is operating 0 = A/D converter module is shutoff and consumes no operating current Note 1: These channels are not available on the 28-pin devices.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 121
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 11-2: ADCON1 REGISTER (ADDRESS 9Fh)
U-0 ADFM bit7 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 PCFG3 R/W-0 PCFG2 R/W-0 PCFG1 R/W-0 PCFG0 bit0
R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as 0 - n = Value at POR reset
bit 7:
ADFM: A/D Result format select 1 = Right Justied. 6 most signicant bits of ADRESH are read as 0. 0 = Left Justied. 6 least signicant bits of ADRESL are read as 0.
bit 6-4: Unimplemented: Read as '0' bit 3-0: PCFG3:PCFG0: A/D Port Conguration Control bits
PCFG3: AN7(1) AN6(1) AN5(1) PCFG0 RE2 RE1 RE0 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 011x 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 A A D D D D D A D D D D D D D A A D D D D D A D D D D D D D A A D D D D D A A A A D D D D
AN4 RA5 A A A A D D D A A A A A D D D
AN3 RA3 A VREF+ A VREF+ A VREF+ D VREF+ A VREF+ VREF+ VREF+ VREF+ D VREF+
AN1 RA1 A A A A A A D A A A A A A D D
AN0 RA0 A A A A A A D A A A A A A A A
VREF+ VDD RA3 VDD RA3 VDD RA3 VDD RA3 VDD RA3 RA3 RA3 RA3 VDD RA3
VREFVSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS RA2 VSS VSS RA2 RA2 RA2 VSS RA2
CHAN / REFS 8/0 7/1 5/0 4/1 3/0 2/1 0/0 6/2 6/0 5/1 4/2 3/2 2/2 1/0 1/2
A = Analog input D = Digital I/O Note 1: These channels are not available on the 28-pin devices.
DS30292A-page 122
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
The ADRESH:ADRESL registers contains the 10-bit result of the A/D conversion. When the A/D conversion is complete, the result is loaded into this A/D result register pair, the GO/DONE bit (ADCON0<2>) is cleared, and A/D interrupt ag bit ADIF is set. The block diagram of the A/D module is shown in Figure 11-3. After the A/D module has been congured as desired, the selected channel must be acquired before the conversion is started. The analog input channels must have their corresponding TRIS bits selected as inputs. To determine sample time, see Section 11.1. After this acquisition time has elapsed the A/D conversion can be started. The following steps should be followed for doing an A/D conversion: 1. Congure the A/D module: Congure analog pins / voltage reference / and digital I/O (ADCON1) Select A/D input channel (ADCON0) Select A/D conversion clock (ADCON0) Turn on A/D module (ADCON0) Congure A/D interrupt (if desired): Clear ADIF bit Set ADIE bit Set GIE bit Wait the required acquisition time. Start conversion: Set GO/DONE bit (ADCON0) Wait for A/D conversion to complete, by either: Polling for the GO/DONE bit to be cleared OR 6. 7. Waiting for the A/D interrupt Read A/D Result register pair (ADRESH:ADRESL), clear bit ADIF if required. For next conversion, go to step 1 or step 2 as required. The A/D conversion time per bit is dened as TAD. A minimum wait of 2TAD is required before next acquisition starts.
2.
3. 4. 5.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 123
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 11-3: A/D BLOCK DIAGRAM
CHS2:CHS0
111 110 101 100 VAIN (Input voltage) 011 010 A/D Converter 001
VDD VREF+ (Reference voltage) PCFG3:PCFG0 00XX or 0X0X or 1000 or 1010 or 1100 VREF(Reference voltage) VSS PCFG3:PCFG0 1001 or 1011 or 1101 X000 or X010 or X100 X001 or X011 or X101
000 RA0/AN0
DS30292A-page 124
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
Figure 11-4 shows the conversion sequence, and the terms that are used. Acquisition time is the time that the A/D modules holding capacitor is connected to the external voltage level. Then there is the conversion time of 12 TAD, which is started when the GO bit is set. The sum of these two times is the sampling time. There is a minimum acquisition time to ensure that the holding capacitor is charged to a level that will give the desired accuracy for the A/D conversion.
A/D conversion complete, result is loaded in ADRES register. Holding capacitor begins acquiring voltage level on selected channel ADIF bit is set
When A/D holding capacitor starts to charge. After A/D conversion, or when new A/D channel is selected
11.1
For the A/D converter to meet its specied accuracy, the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully charge to the input channel voltage level. The analog input model is shown in Figure 11-5. The source impedance (RS) and the internal sampling switch (RSS) impedance directly affect the time required to charge the capacitor CHOLD. The sampling switch (RSS) impedance varies over the device voltage (VDD), Figure 11-5. The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 kW. As the impedance is decreased, the acquisition time may be decreased. After the analog input channel is selected (changed) this acquisition must be done before the conversion can be started.
To calculate the minimum acquisition time, Equation 11-1 may be used. This equation assumes that 1/2 LSb error is used (1024 steps for the A/D). The 1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed for the A/D to meet its specied resolution. Example 11-1 shows the calculation of the minimum required acquisition time TACQ. This calculation is based on the following application system assumptions. CHOLD Rs Conversion Error VDD Temperature VHOLD = = = = = 120 pF 10 k 1/2 LSb 5V Rss = 7 k (see graph in Figure 11-5) 50C (system max.) 0V @ time = 0
EQUATION 11-1:
TACQ = =
ACQUISITION TIME
Amplier Settling Time + Holding Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefcient TAMP + TC + TCOFF
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 125
PIC16F87X
EQUATION 11-2:
VHOLD or Tc = =
(VREF - (VREF/2048)) (1 - e(-Tc/CHOLD(RIC + RSS + RS))) -(120 pF)(1 k + RSS + RS) ln(1/2047)
TAMP + TC + TCOFF
2 s + Tc + [(Temp - 25C)(0.05 s/C)] -CHOLD (RIC + RSS + RS) ln(1/2047) -120 pF (1 k + 7 k + 10 k) ln(0.0004885) -120 pF (18 k) ln(0.0004885) -2.16 s (-7.6241) 16.47 s 2 s + 16.47 s + [(50C - 25C)(0.05 s/C)] 18.447 s + 1.25 s 19.72 s
TACQ =
Note 1: The reference voltage (VREF) has no effect on the equation, since it cancels itself out. Note 2: The charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) is not discharged after each conversion. Note 3: The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 k. This is required to meet the pin leakage specication. Note 4: After a conversion has completed, a 2.0TAD delay must complete before acquisition can begin again. During this time the holding capacitor is not connected to the selected A/D input channel.
Rs
ANx
VA
CPIN 5 pF
VT = 0.6V
I leakage 500 nA
RIC SS CHOLD
6V 5V VDD 4V 3V 2V
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Sampling Switch ( k )
DS30292A-page 126
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
11.2 Selecting the A/D Conversion Clock
The A/D conversion time per bit is dened as TAD. The A/D conversion requires a minimum 12TAD per 10-bit conversion. The source of the A/D conversion clock is software selected. The four possible options for TAD are: 2TOSC 8TOSC 32TOSC Internal RC oscillator For correct A/D conversions, the A/D conversion clock (TAD) must be selected to ensure a minimum TAD time of 1.6 s. Table 11-1 and Table 11-2 show the resultant TAD times derived from the device operating frequencies and the A/D clock source selected.
TABLE 11-1
AD Clock Source (TAD) Operation 2TOSC 8TOSC 32TOSC RC Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: ADCS1:ADCS0 00 01 10 11
1.6 s 2 - 6 s(1, 4)
Shaded cells are are outside of recommended ranges. The RC source has a typical TAD time of 4 s. These values violate the minimum required TAD time. For faster conversion times, the selection of another clock source is recommended. When the device frequencies is greater than 1 MHz, the RC A/D conversion clock source is only recommended for sleep operation. 5: For extended voltage devices (LC), please refer to Electrical Specications section.
11.3
The ADCON1, and TRIS registers control the operation of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are desired as analog inputs must have their corresponding TRIS bits set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared (output), the digital output level (VOH or VOL) will be converted. The A/D operation is independent of the state of the CHS2:CHS0 bits and the TRIS bits. Note 1: When reading the port register, any pin congured as an analog input channel will read as cleared (a low level). Pins congured as digital inputs, will convert an analog input. Analog levels on a digitally congured input will not affect the conversion accuracy. Note 2: Analog levels on any pin that is dened as a digital input (including the AN7:AN0 pins), may cause the input buffer to consume current that is out of the devices specication.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 127
PIC16F87X
11.4 A/D Conversions
Example 11-1 shows how to perform an A/D conversion. The analog pins are congured as analog inputs. The analog references (VREF) are the device VDD and VSS. The A/D interrupt is enabled, and the A/D conversion clock is FRC, with the result being left justied. The conversion is performed on the RA0/AN0 pin (channel 0). Note: The GO/DONE bit should NOT be set in the same instruction that turns on the A/D. Clearing the GO/DONE bit during a conversion will abort the current conversion. The A/D result register pair will NOT be updated with the partially completed A/D conversion sample. That is, the ADRESH:ADRESL registers will continue to contain the value of the last completed conversion (or the last value written to the ADRESH:ADRESL registers). After the A/D conversion is aborted, a 2TAD wait is required before the next acquisition is started. After this 2TAD wait, acquisition on the selected channel is automatically started. In Figure 11-6, after the GO bit is set, the rst time segmant has a minimum of TCY and a maximum of TAD.
Ensure that the required sampling time for the selected input channel has elapsed. Then the conversion may be started. BSF : : ADCON0, GO ; Start A/D Conversion ; The ADIF bit will be set and the GO/DONE bit ; is cleared upon completion of the A/D Conversion.
DS30292A-page 128
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 11-7: FLOWCHART OF A/D OPERATION
ADON = 0
Yes ADON = 0?
Yes GO = 0?
No
Yes
Device in SLEEP? No
Yes
Wait 2TAD
No
Wait 2TAD
Wait 2TAD
11.4.1
The ADRESH:ADRESL register pair is the location where the 10-bit A/D result is loaded at the completion of the A/D conversion. This register pair is 16-bits wide. The A/D module gives the exibility to left or right justify the 10-bit result in the 16-bit result register. The A/D Format Select bit (ADFM) controls this justication. Figure 11-8 shows the operation of the A/D result justication. The extra bits are loaded with 0s. When an A/D result will not overwrite these locations (A/D disable), these registers may be used as two general purpose 8-bit registers.
SLEEP. If the A/D interrupt is not enabled, the A/D module will then be turned off, although the ADON bit will remain set. When the A/D clock source is another clock option (not RC), a SLEEP instruction will cause the present conversion to be aborted and the A/D module to be turned off, though the ADON bit will remain set. Turning off the A/D places the A/D module in its lowest current consumption state. Note: For the A/D module to operate in SLEEP, the A/D clock source must be set to RC (ADCS1:ADCS0 = 11). To allow the conversion to occur during SLEEP, ensure the SLEEP instruction immediately follows the instruction that sets the GO/DONE bit.
11.5
The A/D module can operate during SLEEP mode. This requires that the A/D clock source be set to RC (ADCS1:ADCS0 = 11). When the RC clock source is selected, the A/D module waits one instruction cycle before starting the conversion. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed, which eliminates all digital switching noise from the conversion. When the conversion is completed the GO/DONE bit will be cleared, and the result loaded into the ADRES register. If the A/D interrupt is enabled, the device will wake-up from
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 129
PIC16F87X
11.6 Effects of a Reset
A device reset forces all registers to their reset state. This forces the A/D module to be turned off, and any conversion is aborted. The value that is in the ADRESH:ADRESL registers is not modied for a Power-on Reset. The ADRESH:ADRESL registers will contain unknown data after a Power-on Reset.
ADFM = 1
ADFM = 0
7 0000 00
2107
0765 0000 00
ADRESH
ADRESL
ADRESH
ADRESL
11.7
A/D Accuracy/Error
In systems where the device frequency is low, use of the A/D RC clock is preferred. At moderate to high frequencies, TAD should be derived from the device oscillator. The absolute accuracy specied for the A/D converter includes the sum of all contributions for quantization error, integral error, differential error, full scale error, offset error, and monotonicity. It is dened as the maximum deviation from an actual transition versus an ideal transition for any code. The absolute error of the A/D converter is specied at < 1 LSb for VDD = VREF (over the devices specied operating range). However, the accuracy of the A/D converter will degrade as VREF diverges from VDD. For a given range of analog inputs, the output digital code will be the same. This is due to the quantization of the analog input to a digital code. Quantization error is typically 1/2 LSb and is inherent in the analog to digital conversion process. The only way to reduce quantization error is to increase the resolution of the A/D converter or oversample. Offset error measures the rst actual transition of a code versus the rst ideal transition of a code. Offset error shifts the entire transfer function. Offset error can be calibrated out of a system or introduced into a system through the interaction of the total leakage current and source impedance at the analog input. Gain error measures the maximum deviation of the last actual transition and the last ideal transition adjusted for offset error. This error appears as a change in slope of the transfer function. The difference in gain error to
full scale error is that full scale does not take offset error into account. Gain error can be calibrated out in software. Linearity error refers to the uniformity of the code changes. Linearity errors cannot be calibrated out of the system. Integral non-linearity error measures the actual code transition versus the ideal code transition adjusted by the gain error for each code. Differential non-linearity measures the maximum actual code width versus the ideal code width. This measure is unadjusted. The maximum pin leakage current is specied in the Device Data Sheet electrical specication parameter #D060. In systems where the device frequency is low, use of the A/D RC clock is preferred. At moderate to high frequencies, TAD should be derived from the device oscillator. TAD must not violate the minimum and should be minimized to reduce inaccuracies due to noise and sampling capacitor bleed off. In systems where the device will enter SLEEP mode after the start of the A/D conversion, the RC clock source selection is required. In this mode, the digital noise from the modules in SLEEP are stopped. This method gives high accuracy.
DS30292A-page 130
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
11.8 Connection Considerations FIGURE 11-9: A/D TRANSFER FUNCTION
3FFh Digital code output3 FEh
If the input voltage exceeds the rail values (VSS or VDD) by greater than 0.3V, then the accuracy of the conversion is out of specication. An external RC lter is sometimes added for anti-aliasing of the input signal. The R component should be selected to ensure that the total source impedance is kept under the 10 k recommended specication. Any external components connected (via hi-impedance) to an analog input pin (capacitor, zener diode, etc.) should have very little leakage current at the pin.
11.9
Transfer Function
000h 0.5 LSb 1.5 LSb 2.5 LSb 1 LSb 2 LSb 3 LSb
1022.5 LSb
11.10
References
A good reference for the undestanding A/D converter is the "Analog-Digital Conversion Handbook" third edition, published by Prentice Hall (ISBN 0-13-03-2848-0).
TABLE 11-2
Addr 0Bh 0Ch 8Ch 1Eh 9Eh 1Fh 9Fh 85h 05h 89h(1) 09h(1) Legend: Note 1: Name INTCON PIR1 PIE1 ADRESH ADRESL ADCON0 ADCON1 TRISA PORTA TRISE PORTE
POR, BOR 0000 000x 0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx
MCLR, WDT 0000 000u 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu 0000 00-0 --0- 0000 --11 1111 --0u 0000 0000 -111 ---- -uuu
PSPIE(1)
A/D Result Register High Byte A/D Result Register Low Byte ADCS1 ADFM IBF ADCS0 OBF CHS2 CHS1 CHS0 PCFG3 GO/DONE PCFG2 PCFG1 ADON PCFG0
0000 00-0 --0- 0000 --11 1111 --0x 0000 0000 -111
PORTA Data Direction Register PORTA Data Latch when written: PORTA pins when read IBOV PSPMODE PORTE Data Direction Bits RE2 RE1 RE0
---- -xxx
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as '0'. Shaded cells are not used for A/D conversion. These registers/bits are not available on the 28-pin devices.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 131
1023.5 LSb
1022 LSb
1023 LSb
The transfer function of the A/D converter is as follows: the rst transition occurs when the analog input voltage (VAIN) equals Analog VREF / 1024 (Figure 11-9).
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 132
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
12.0 SPECIAL FEATURES OF THE CPU
12.1 Conguration Bits
The conguration bits can be programmed (read as '0') or left unprogrammed (read as '1') to select various device congurations. These bits are mapped in program memory location 2007h. The user will note that address 2007h is beyond the user program memory space. In fact, it belongs to the special test/conguration memory space (2000h 3FFFh), which can be accessed only during programming.
These PICmicros have a host of features intended to maximize system reliability, minimize cost through elimination of external components, provide power saving operating modes and offer code protection. These are: OSC Selection Reset - Power-on Reset (POR) - Power-up Timer (PWRT) - Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) - Brown-out Reset (BOR) Interrupts Watchdog Timer (WDT) SLEEP Code protection ID locations In-circuit serial programming Low Voltage Programming In-Circuit Debugger These devices have a Watchdog Timer which can be shut off only through conguration bits. It runs off its own RC oscillator for added reliability. There are two timers that offer necessary delays on power-up. One is the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST), intended to keep the chip in reset until the crystal oscillator is stable. The other is the Power-up Timer (PWRT), which provides a xed delay of 72 ms (nominal) on power-up only, designed to keep the part in reset while the power supply stabilizes. With these two timers on-chip, most applications need no external reset circuitry. SLEEP mode is designed to offer a very low current power-down mode. The user can wake-up from SLEEP through external reset, Watchdog Timer Wake-up, or through an interrupt. Several oscillator options are also made available to allow the part to t the application. The RC oscillator option saves system cost while the LP crystal option saves power. A set of conguration bits are used to select various options. Additional information on special features is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 133
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-1: CONFIGURATION WORD
CP1 bit13 CP0 BKBUG WRT CPD LVP BODEN CP1 CP0 PWRTE WDTE F0SC1 F0SC0 bit0
Register: Address
CONFIG 2007h
bit 13-12: bit 5-4: CP1:CP0: Flash Program Memory Code Protection bits (2) 11 = Code protection off 10 = 1F00h to 1FFFh code protected (PIC16F877, 876) 10 = 0F00h to 0FFFh code protected (PIC16F874, 873) 01 = 1000h to 1FFFh code protected (PIC16F877, 876) 01 = 0800h to 0FFFh code protected (PIC16F874, 873) 00 = 0000h to 1FFFh code protected (PIC16F877, 876) 00 = 0000h to 0FFFh code protected (PIC16F874, 873) bit 11: DEBUG: In-Circuit Debugger Mode 1 = In-Circuit Debugger disabled, RB6 and RB7 are general purpose I/O pins. 0 = In-Circuit Debugger enabled, RB6 and RB7 are dedicated to the debugger. bit 10: Unimplemented: Read as 1 bit 9: WRT: Flash Program Memory Write Enable 1 = Unprotected program memory may be written to by EECON control 0 = Unprotected program memory may not be written to by EECON control bit 8: CPD: Data EE Memory Code Protection 1 = Code protection off 0 = Data EEPROM memory code protected bit 7: LVP: Low voltage programming Enable bit 1 = RB3/PGM pin has PGM function, low voltage programming enabled 0 = RB3 is digital I/O, HV on MCLR must be used for programming BODEN: Brown-out Reset Enable bit (1) 1 = BOR enabled 0 = BOR disabled PWRTE: Power-up Timer Enable bit (1) 1 = PWRT disabled 0 = PWRT enabled WDTE: Watchdog Timer Enable bit 1 = WDT enabled 0 = WDT disabled FOSC1:FOSC0: Oscillator Selection bits 11 = RC oscillator 10 = HS oscillator 01 = XT oscillator 00 = LP oscillator
bit 6:
bit 3:
bit 2:
bit 1-0:
Note 1: Enabling Brown-out Reset automatically enables Power-up Timer (PWRT) regardless of the value of bit PWRTE. Ensure the Power-up Timer is enabled anytime Brown-out Reset is enabled. 2: All of the CP1:CP0 pairs have to be given the same value to enable the code protection scheme listed.
12.2
12.2.1
Oscillator Congurations
OSCILLATOR TYPES
12.2.2
The PIC16F87X can be operated in four different oscillator modes. The user can program two conguration bits (FOSC1 and FOSC0) to select one of these four modes: LP XT HS RC Low Power Crystal Crystal/Resonator High Speed Crystal/Resonator Resistor/Capacitor
In XT, LP or HS modes a crystal or ceramic resonator is connected to the OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT pins to establish oscillation (Figure 12-2). The PIC16F87X Oscillator design requires the use of a parallel cut crystal. Use of a series cut crystal may give a frequency out of the crystal manufacturers specications. When in XT, LP or HS modes, the device can have an external clock source to drive the OSC1/CLKIN pin (Figure 12-3).
DS30292A-page 134
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-2: CRYSTAL/CERAMIC RESONATOR OPERATION (HS, XT OR LP OSC CONFIGURATION)
C1(1) OSC1 To internal logic SLEEP PIC16F87X
HS
TABLE 12-2
Osc Type LP XT
RF(3)
Note1:See Table 12-1 and Table 12-2 for recommended values of C1 and C2. 2:A series resistor (RS) may be required for AT strip cut crystals.
These values are for design guidance only. See notes at bottom of page. Crystals Used 32 kHz 200 kHz Epson C-001R32.768K-A STD XTL 200.000KHz ECS ECS-10-13-1 ECS ECS-40-20-1 EPSON CA-301 8.000M-C EPSON CA-301 20.000M-C 20 PPM 20 PPM 50 PPM 50 PPM 30 PPM 30 PPM
TABLE 12-1
Ranges Tested: Mode XT
CERAMIC RESONATORS
Freq 455 kHz 2.0 MHz 4.0 MHz 8.0 MHz 16.0 MHz
OSC1 68 - 100 pF 15 - 68 pF 15 - 68 pF 10 - 68 pF 10 - 22 pF
OSC2 68 - 100 pF 15 - 68 pF 15 - 68 pF 10 - 68 pF 10 - 22 pF
Note 1: Recommended values of C1 and C2 are identical to the ranges tested (Table 12-1). 2: Higher capacitance increases the stability of oscillator but also increases the start-up time. 3: Since each resonator/crystal has its own characteristics, the user should consult the resonator/crystal manufacturer for appropriate values of external components. 4: Rs may be required in HS mode as well as XT mode to avoid overdriving crystals with low drive level specication. 12.2.3 RC OSCILLATOR
HS
These values are for design guidance only. See notes at bottom of page.
Resonators Used: 455 kHz 2.0 MHz 4.0 MHz 8.0 MHz 16.0 MHz Panasonic EFO-A455K04B Murata Erie CSA2.00MG Murata Erie CSA4.00MG Murata Erie CSA8.00MT Murata Erie CSA16.00MX 0.3% 0.5% 0.5% 0.5% 0.5%
For timing insensitive applications the RC device option offers additional cost savings. The RC oscillator frequency is a function of the supply voltage, the resistor (REXT) and capacitor (CEXT) values, and the operating temperature. In addition to this, the oscillator frequency will vary from unit to unit due to normal process parameter variation. Furthermore, the difference in lead frame capacitance between package types will also affect the oscillation frequency, especially for low CEXT values. The user also needs to take into account variation due to tolerance of external R and C components used. Figure 12-4 shows how the R/C combination is connected to the PIC16F87X.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 135
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-4: RC OSCILLATOR MODE
VDD Rext OSC1 Cext VSS Fosc/4 Recommended values: OSC2/CLKOUT 3 k Rext 100 k Cext > 20pF Internal clock PIC16F87X
12.3
Reset
The PIC16F87X differentiates between various kinds of reset: Power-on Reset (POR) MCLR reset during normal operation MCLR reset during SLEEP WDT Reset (during normal operation) WDT Wake-up (during SLEEP) Brown-out Reset (BOR)
Some registers are not affected in any reset condition; their status is unknown on POR and unchanged in any other reset. Most other registers are reset to a reset state on Power-on Reset (POR), on the MCLR and WDT Reset, on MCLR reset during SLEEP, and Brownout Reset (BOR). They are not affected by a WDT Wake-up, which is viewed as the resumption of normal operation. The TO and PD bits are set or cleared differently in different reset situations as indicated in Table 12-4. These bits are used in software to determine the nature of the reset. See Table 12-6 for a full description of reset states of all registers. A simplied block diagram of the on-chip reset circuit is shown in Figure 12-5. These devices have a MCLR noise lter in the MCLR reset path. The lter will detect and ignore small pulses. It should be noted that a WDT Reset does not drive MCLR pin low.
DS30292A-page 136
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-5: SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
External Reset MCLR WDT Module Vdd rise detect Vdd Brown-out Reset OST/PWRT OST 10-bit Ripple counter OSC1 (1) On-chip RC OSC PWRT 10-bit Ripple counter R Q Chip_Reset Power-on Reset S WDT SLEEP
Time-out Reset
BODEN
Note 1:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 137
PIC16F87X
12.4 Power-On Reset (POR) 12.5 Power-up Timer (PWRT)
A Power-on Reset pulse is generated on-chip when VDD rise is detected (in the range of 1.2V - 1.7V). To take advantage of the POR, just tie the MCLR pin directly (or through a resistor) to VDD. This will eliminate external RC components usually needed to create a Power-on Reset. A maximum rise time for VDD is specied. See Electrical Specications for details. For a slow rise time, see Figure 12-6. When the device starts normal operation (exits the reset condition), device operating parameters (voltage, frequency, temperature,...) must be met to ensure operation. If these conditions are not met, the device must be held in reset until the operating conditions are met. Brown-out Reset may be used to meet the start-up conditions. The Power-up Timer provides a xed 72 ms nominal time-out on power-up only, from the POR. The Powerup Timer operates on an internal RC oscillator. The chip is kept in reset as long as the PWRT is active. The PWRTs time delay allows VDD to rise to an acceptable level. A conguration bit is provided to enable/disable the PWRT. The power-up time delay will vary from chip to chip due to VDD, temperature, and process variation. See DC parameters for details.
12.6
FIGURE 12-6: EXTERNAL POWER-ON RESET CIRCUIT (FOR SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
VDD D
The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) provides 1024 oscillator cycle (from OSC1 input) delay after the PWRT delay is over. This ensures that the crystal oscillator or resonator has started and stabilized. The OST time-out is invoked only for XT, LP and HS modes and only on Power-on Reset or wake-up from SLEEP.
12.7
R R1 MCLR C PIC16F87X
Note 1: External Power-on Reset circuit is required only if VDD power-up slope is too slow. The diode D helps discharge the capacitor quickly when VDD powers down. 2: R < 40 k is recommended to make sure that voltage drop across R does not violate the devices electrical specication. 3: R1 = 100 to 1 k will limit any current owing into MCLR from external capacitor C in the event of MCLR/VPP pin breakdown due to Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) or Electrical Overstress (EOS).
A conguration bit, BODEN, can disable (if clear/programmed) or enable (if set) the Brown-out Reset circuitry. If VDD falls below 4.0V (3.8V - 4.2V range) for greater than parameter #35, the brown-out situation will reset the chip. A reset may not occur if VDD falls below 4.0V for less than parameter #35. The chip will remain in Brown-out Reset until VDD rises above BVDD. The Power-up Timer will now be invoked and will keep the chip in RESET an additional 72 ms. If VDD drops below BVDD while the Power-up Timer is running, the chip will go back into a Brown-out Reset and the Power-up Timer will be initialized. Once VDD rises above BVDD, the Power-up Timer will execute a 72 ms time delay. The Power-up Timer should always be enabled when Brown-out Reset is enabled.
DS30292A-page 138
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
12.8 Time-out Sequence 12.9
On power-up the time-out sequence is as follows: First PWRT time-out is invoked after the POR time delay has expired. Then OST is activated. The total time-out will vary based on oscillator conguration and the status of the PWRT. For example, in RC mode with the PWRT disabled, there will be no time-out at all. Figure 12-7, Figure 12-8, Figure 12-9 and Figure 12-10 depict timeout sequences on power-up. Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR is kept low long enough, the time-outs will expire. Then bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately (Figure 12-9). This is useful for testing purposes or to synchronize more than one PIC16F87X device operating in parallel. Table 12-5 shows the reset conditions for some special function registers, while Table 12-6 shows the reset conditions for all the registers.
The Power Control/Status Register, PCON has up to two bits, depending upon the device. Bit0 is Brown-out Reset Status bit, BOR. Bit BOR is unknown on a Power-on Reset. It must then be set by the user and checked on subsequent resets to see if bit BOR cleared, indicating a BOR occurred. The BOR bit is a "Dont Care" bit and is not necessarily predictable if the Brown-out Reset circuitry is disabled (by clearing bit BODEN in the Conguration Word). Bit1 is POR (Power-on Reset Status bit). It is cleared on a Power-on Reset and unaffected otherwise. The user must set this bit following a Power-on Reset.
TABLE 12-3
TABLE 12-4
POR 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 BOR x x x 0 1 1 1 1
TABLE 12-5
Power-on Reset MCLR Reset during normal operation MCLR Reset during SLEEP WDT Reset WDT Wake-up Brown-out Reset Interrupt wake-up from SLEEP
Note 1:
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 139
PIC16F87X
TABLE 12-6
Register W INDF TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR PORTA PORTB PORTC PORTD PORTE PCLATH INTCON PIR1 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 PIR2 TMR1L TMR1H T1CON TMR2 T2CON SSPBUF SSPCON CCPR1L CCPR1H CCP1CON RCSTA TXREG RCREG CCPR2L CCPR2H CCP2CON ADRESH ADCON0 OPTION_REG TRISA 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as '0', q = value depends on condition, r = reserved maintain clear. Note 1: One or more bits in INTCON, PIR1 and/or PIR2 will be affected (to cause wake-up). 2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h). 3: See Table 12-5 for reset value for specic condition.
DS30292A-page 140
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 12-6
Register TRISB TRISC TRISD TRISE PIE1 PIE2 PCON PR2 SSPADD SSPSTAT TXSTA SPBRG ADRESL ADCON1 EEDATA EEADR EEDATH EEADRH EECON1 EECON2 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873 873
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as '0', q = value depends on condition, r = reserved maintain clear. Note 1: One or more bits in INTCON, PIR1 and/or PIR2 will be affected (to cause wake-up). 2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h). 3: See Table 12-5 for reset value for specic condition.
Vdd
PWRT TIME-OUT
Tost
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 141
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-8: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
Vdd
PWRT TIME-OUT
Tost
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 12-9: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
Vdd
PWRT TIME-OUT
Tost
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
DS30292A-page 142
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
12.10 Interrupts
The PIC16F87X family has up to 14 sources of interrupt. The interrupt control register (INTCON) records individual interrupt requests in ag bits. It also has individual and global interrupt enable bits. Note: Individual interrupt ag bits are set regardless of the status of their corresponding mask bit or the GIE bit.
A global interrupt enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>) enables (if set) all un-masked interrupts or disables (if cleared) all interrupts. When bit GIE is enabled, and an interrupts ag bit and mask bit are set, the interrupt will vector immediately. Individual interrupts can be disabled through their corresponding enable bits in various registers. Individual interrupt bits are set regardless of the status of the GIE bit. The GIE bit is cleared on reset. The return from interrupt instruction, RETFIE, exits the interrupt routine as well as sets the GIE bit, which re-enables interrupts. The RB0/INT pin interrupt, the RB port change interrupt and the TMR0 overow interrupt ags are contained in the INTCON register. The peripheral interrupt ags are contained in the special function registers PIR1 and PIR2. The corresponding interrupt enable bits are contained in special function registers PIE1 and PIE2, and the peripheral interrupt enable bit is contained in special function register INTCON. When an interrupt is responded to, the GIE bit is cleared to disable any further interrupt, the return address is pushed onto the stack and the PC is loaded with 0004h. Once in the interrupt service routine the source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling the interrupt ag bits. The interrupt ag bit(s) must be cleared in software before re-enabling interrupts to avoid recursive interrupts. For external interrupt events, such as the INT pin or PORTB change interrupt, the interrupt latency will be three or four instruction cycles. The exact latency depends when the interrupt event occurs. The latency is the same for one or two cycle instructions. Individual interrupt ag bits are set regardless of the status of their corresponding mask bit or the GIE bit
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 143
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-11: INTERRUPT LOGIC
EEIF EEIE PSPIF PSPIE ADIF ADIE RCIF RCIE TXIF TXIE SSPIF SSPIE CCP1IF CCP1IE TMR2IF TMR2IE TMR1IF TMR1IE CCP2IF CCP2IE BCLIF BCLIE T0IF T0IE INTF INTE RBIF RBIE PEIE GIE Wake-up (If in SLEEP mode)
Interrupt to CPU
DS30292A-page 144
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
12.10.1 INT INTERRUPT External interrupt on RB0/INT pin is edge triggered: either rising if bit INTEDG (OPTION_REG<6>) is set, or falling, if the INTEDG bit is clear. When a valid edge appears on the RB0/INT pin, ag bit INTF (INTCON<1>) is set. This interrupt can be disabled by clearing enable bit INTE (INTCON<4>). Flag bit INTF must be cleared in software in the interrupt service routine before re-enabling this interrupt. The INT interrupt can wake-up the processor from SLEEP, if bit INTE was set prior to going into SLEEP. The status of global interrupt enable bit GIE decides whether or not the processor branches to the interrupt vector following wake-up. See Section 12.13 for details on SLEEP mode. 12.10.2 TMR0 INTERRUPT An overow (FFh 00h) in the TMR0 register will set ag bit T0IF (INTCON<2>). The interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit T0IE (INTCON<5>). (Section 5.0) 12.10.3 PORTB INTCON CHANGE An input change on PORTB<7:4> sets ag bit RBIF (INTCON<0>). The interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit RBIE (INTCON<4>). (Section 3.2)
12.11
During an interrupt, only the return PC value is saved on the stack. Typically, users may wish to save key registers during an interrupt, i.e., W register and STATUS register. This will have to be implemented in software. Example 12-1 stores and restores the W and STATUS registers. The register, W_TEMP, must be dened in each bank and must be dened at the same offset from the bank base address (i.e., if W_TEMP is dened at 0x20 in bank 0, it must also be dened at 0xA0 in bank 1). The example: a) b) c) d) e) f) Stores the W register. Stores the STATUS register in bank 0. Stores the PCLATH register. Executes the interrupt service routine code (User-generated). Restores the STATUS register (and bank select bit). Restores the W and PCLATH registers.
;Restore PCLATH ;Move W into PCLATH ;Swap STATUS_TEMP register into W ;(sets bank to original state) ;Move W into STATUS register ;Swap W_TEMP ;Swap W_TEMP into W
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 145
PIC16F87X
12.12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
The Watchdog Timer is as a free running on-chip RC oscillator which does not require any external components. This RC oscillator is separate from the RC oscillator of the OSC1/CLKIN pin. That means that the WDT will run, even if the clock on the OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT pins of the device has been stopped, for example, by execution of a SLEEP instruction. During normal operation, a WDT time-out generates a device RESET (Watchdog Timer Reset). If the device is in SLEEP mode, a WDT time-out causes the device to wake-up and continue with normal operation (Watchdog Timer Wake-up). The TO bit in the STATUS register will be cleared upon a Watchdog Timer time-out. The WDT can be permanently disabled by clearing conguration bit WDTE (Section 12.1). WDT time-out period values may be found in the Electrical Specications section under parameter #31. Values for the WDT prescaler (actually a postscaler, but shared with the Timer0 prescaler) may be assigned using the OPTION_REG register. Note: The CLRWDT and SLEEP instructions clear the WDT and the postscaler, if assigned to the WDT, and prevent it from timing out and generating a device RESET condition.
. Note: When a CLRWDT instruction is executed and the prescaler is assigned to the WDT, the prescaler count will be cleared, but the prescaler assignment is not changed.
PS2:PS0
WDT Time-out
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer. Note 1: See Figure 12-1 for operation of these bits.
DS30292A-page 146
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
12.13 Power-down Mode (SLEEP)
Other peripherals cannot generate interrupts since during SLEEP, no on-chip clocks are present. When the SLEEP instruction is being executed, the next instruction (PC + 1) is pre-fetched. For the device to wake-up through an interrupt event, the corresponding interrupt enable bit must be set (enabled). Wake-up is regardless of the state of the GIE bit. If the GIE bit is clear (disabled), the device continues execution at the instruction after the SLEEP instruction. If the GIE bit is set (enabled), the device executes the instruction after the SLEEP instruction and then branches to the interrupt address (0004h). In cases where the execution of the instruction following SLEEP is not desirable, the user should have a NOP after the SLEEP instruction. 12.13.2 WAKE-UP USING INTERRUPTS When global interrupts are disabled (GIE cleared) and any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit and interrupt ag bit set, one of the following will occur: If the interrupt occurs before the execution of a SLEEP instruction, the SLEEP instruction will complete as a NOP. Therefore, the WDT and WDT postscaler will not be cleared, the TO bit will not be set and PD bits will not be cleared. If the interrupt occurs during or after the execution of a SLEEP instruction, the device will immediately wake up from sleep. The SLEEP instruction will be completely executed before the wake-up. Therefore, the WDT and WDT postscaler will be cleared, the TO bit will be set and the PD bit will be cleared. Even if the ag bits were checked before executing a SLEEP instruction, it may be possible for flag bits to become set before the SLEEP instruction completes. To determine whether a SLEEP instruction executed, test the PD bit. If the PD bit is set, the SLEEP instruction was executed as a NOP. To ensure that the WDT is cleared, a CLRWDT instruction should be executed before a SLEEP instruction. Power-down mode is entered by executing a SLEEP instruction. If enabled, the Watchdog Timer will be cleared but keeps running, the PD bit (STATUS<3>) is cleared, the TO (STATUS<4>) bit is set, and the oscillator driver is turned off. The I/O ports maintain the status they had, before the SLEEP instruction was executed (driving high, low, or hi-impedance). For lowest current consumption in this mode, place all I/O pins at either VDD, or VSS, ensure no external circuitry is drawing current from the I/O pin, power-down the A/D, disable external clocks. Pull all I/O pins, that are hi-impedance inputs, high or low externally to avoid switching currents caused by oating inputs. The T0CKI input should also be at VDD or VSS for lowest current consumption. The contribution from on-chip pull-ups on PORTB should be considered. The MCLR pin must be at a logic high level (VIHMC). 12.13.1 WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP The device can wake up from SLEEP through one of the following events: 1. 2. 3. External reset input on MCLR pin. Watchdog Timer Wake-up (if WDT was enabled). Interrupt from INT pin, RB port change, or some Peripheral Interrupts.
External MCLR Reset will cause a device reset. All other events are considered a continuation of program execution and cause a "wake-up". The TO and PD bits in the STATUS register can be used to determine the cause of device reset. The PD bit, which is set on power-up, is cleared when SLEEP is invoked. The TO bit is cleared if a WDT time-out occurred (and caused wake-up). The following peripheral interrupts can wake the device from SLEEP: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. PSP read or write. TMR1 interrupt. Timer1 must be operating as an asynchronous counter. CCP capture mode interrupt. Special event trigger (Timer1 in asynchronous mode using an external clock). SSP (Start/Stop) bit detect interrupt. SSP transmit or receive in slave mode (SPI/I2C). USART RX or TX (synchronous slave mode). A/D conversion (when A/D clock source is RC). EEPROM Write operation completion
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 147
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 12-14: WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP THROUGH INTERRUPT
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 OSC1 CLKOUT(4) INT pin INTF ag (INTCON<1>) GIE bit (INTCON<7>) INSTRUCTION FLOW PC PC PC+1 Inst(PC + 1) SLEEP PC+2 PC+2 Inst(PC + 2) Inst(PC + 1) Dummy cycle PC + 2 0004h Inst(0004h) Dummy cycle 0005h Inst(0005h) Inst(0004h) Instruction Inst(PC) = SLEEP fetched Instruction Inst(PC - 1) executed Note 1: 2: 3: 4: Processor in SLEEP Interrupt Latency (Note 2) Tost(2) Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
XT, HS or LP oscillator mode assumed. TOST = 1024TOSC (drawing not to scale) This delay will not be there for RC osc mode. GIE = '1' assumed. In this case after wake- up, the processor jumps to the interrupt routine. If GIE = '0', execution will continue in-line. CLKOUT is not available in these osc modes, but shown here for timing reference.
12.14
In-Circuit Debugger
12.16
ID Locations
When the DEBUG bit in the conguration word is programmed to a '0', the In-Circuit Debugger functionality is enabled. This function allows simple debugging functions when used with MPLAB. When the microcontroller has this feature enabled, some of the resources are not available for general use. Table 12-7 shows which features are consumed by the background debugger.
Four memory locations (2000h - 2003h) are designated as ID locations where the user can store checksum or other code-identication numbers. These locations are not accessible during normal execution but are readable and writable during program/verify. It is recommended that only the 4 least signicant bits of the ID location are used. For ROM devices, these values are submitted along with the ROM code.
TABLE 12-7
I/O pins Stack
DEBUGGER RESOURCES
RB6, RB7 1 level Last 100h words TBD
To use the In-Circuit Debugger function of the microcontroller, the design must implement In-Circuit Serial Programming connections to MCLR/Vpp, Vdd, GND, RB7 and RB6. This will interface to the In-Circuit Debugger module available from Microchip or one of the third party development tool companies.
12.15
If the code protection bit(s) have not been programmed, the on-chip program memory can be read out for verication purposes.
DS30292A-page 148
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
12.17 In-Circuit Serial Programming 12.18 Low Voltage Programming
PIC16F87X microcontrollers can be serially programmed while in the end application circuit. This is simply done with two lines for clock and data, and three other lines for power, ground, and the programming voltage. This allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices, and then program the microcontroller just before shipping the product. This also allows the most recent rmware or a custom rmware to be programmed. The PIC16F87X devices can be programmed only (no bulk operations such as erase) over the entire VDD operating range using ICSP. Please refer to the PIC16F87X Programming Specication, (DS39025). For complete details of serial programming, please refer to the In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) Guide, (DS30277B). The LVP bit of the conguration word enables low voltage programming. This mode allows the microcontroller to be programmed via ICSP using a VDD source in the operating voltage range. This mode removes the requirement of VIHH to be placed on the MCLR pin. The LVP bit is normally erased to '1' which enables the low voltage programming. In this mode, the RB3/PGM pin is dedicated to the programming function and ceases to be a general purpose I/O pin. VDD is applied to the MCLR pin during low voltage programming. The device will enter programming mode when a '1' is placed on the RB3/PGM pin. Note 1: The high voltage programming mode is always available, regardless of the state of the LVP bit, by applying VIMH to the MCLR pin. 2: While in this mode the RB3 pin can no longer be used as a general purpose I/O pin. 3: VDD must be 5.0V +10% during erase/program operations while in low voltage programming mode.
If Low-voltage programming mode is not used, the LVP bit can be programmed to a '0' and RB3/PGM becomes a digital I/O pin. To program the device, VIHH must be placed onto MCLR during programming. The LVP bit may only be programmed when programming is entered with VIHH on MCLR. The LVP bit cannot be programmed when programming is entered with RB3/PGM. It should be noted, that once the LVP bit is programmed to 0, only the high voltage programming mode is available and only high voltage programming mode can be used to program the device.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 149
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 150
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
13.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
Each PIC16CXXX instruction is a 14-bit word divided into an OPCODE which species the instruction type and one or more operands which further specify the operation of the instruction. The PIC16CXX instruction set summary in Table 13-2 lists byte-oriented, bit-oriented, and literal and control operations. Table 13-1 shows the opcode eld descriptions. For byte-oriented instructions, 'f' represents a le register designator and 'd' represents a destination designator. The le register designator species which le register is to be used by the instruction. The destination designator species where the result of the operation is to be placed. If 'd' is zero, the result is placed in the W register. If 'd' is one, the result is placed in the le register specied in the instruction. For bit-oriented instructions, 'b' represents a bit eld designator which selects the number of the bit affected by the operation, while 'f' represents the number of the le in which the bit is located. For literal and control operations, 'k' represents an eight or eleven bit constant or literal value. Table 13-2 lists the instructions recognized by the MPASM assembler. Figure 13-1 shows the general formats that the instructions can have. Note: To maintain upward compatibility with future PIC16CXXX products, do not use the OPTION and TRIS instructions.
All examples use the following format to represent a hexadecimal number: 0xhh where h signies a hexadecimal digit.
d = 0 for destination W d = 1 for destination f f = 7-bit le register address Bit-oriented le register operations 13 10 9 7 6 OPCODE b (BIT #) f (FILE #)
TABLE 13-1
Field
f W b k x
PC TO PD
Register le address (0x00 to 0x7F) Working register (accumulator) Bit address within an 8-bit le register Literal eld, constant data or label Don't care location (= 0 or 1) The assembler will generate code with x = 0. It is the recommended form of use for compatibility with all Microchip software tools. Destination select; d = 0: store result in W, d = 1: store result in le register f. Default is d = 1 Program Counter Time-out bit Power-down bit
b = 3-bit bit address f = 7-bit le register address Literal and control operations General 13 OPCODE k = 8-bit immediate value 8 7 k (literal) 0
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped into three basic categories: Byte-oriented operations Bit-oriented operations Literal and control operations All instructions are executed within one single instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the program counter is changed as a result of an instruction. In this case, the execution takes two instruction cycles with the second cycle executed as a NOP. One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods. Thus, for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, the normal instruction execution time is 1 s. If a conditional test is true or the program counter is changed as a result of an instruction, the instruction execution time is 2 s.
A description of each instruction is available in the PICmicro Mid-Range Reference Manual, (DS33023).
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 151
PIC16F87X
TABLE 13-2
Mnemonic, Operands
BYTE-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS ADDWF ANDWF CLRF CLRW COMF DECF DECFSZ INCF INCFSZ IORWF MOVF MOVWF NOP RLF RRF SUBWF SWAPF XORWF f, d f, d f f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d Add W and f AND W with f Clear f Clear W Complement f Decrement f Decrement f, Skip if 0 Increment f Increment f, Skip if 0 Inclusive OR W with f Move f Move W to f No Operation Rotate Left f through Carry Rotate Right f through Carry Subtract W from f Swap nibbles in f Exclusive OR W with f 1 1 1 1 1 1 1(2) 1 1(2) 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 0111 0101 0001 0001 1001 0011 1011 1010 1111 0100 1000 0000 0000 1101 1100 0010 1110 0110 dfff dfff lfff 0xxx dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff lfff 0xx0 dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff ffff ffff ffff xxxx ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff 0000 ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff C,DC,Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z 1,2 1,2 2 1,2 1,2 1,2,3 1,2 1,2,3 1,2 1,2
C C C,DC,Z Z
BIT-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS BCF BSF BTFSC BTFSS f, b f, b f, b f, b Bit Clear f Bit Set f Bit Test f, Skip if Clear Bit Test f, Skip if Set 1 1 1 (2) 1 (2) 01 01 01 01 00bb 01bb 10bb 11bb bfff bfff bfff bfff ffff ffff ffff ffff 1,2 1,2 3 3
LITERAL AND CONTROL OPERATIONS ADDLW ANDLW CALL CLRWDT GOTO IORLW MOVLW RETFIE RETLW RETURN SLEEP SUBLW XORLW Note 1: k k k k k k k k k Add literal and W AND literal with W Call subroutine Clear Watchdog Timer Go to address Inclusive OR literal with W Move literal to W Return from interrupt Return with literal in W Return from Subroutine Go into standby mode Subtract W from literal Exclusive OR literal with W 1 1 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 11 11 10 00 10 11 11 00 11 00 00 11 11 111x 1001 0kkk 0000 1kkk 1000 00xx 0000 01xx 0000 0000 110x 1010 kkkk kkkk kkkk 0110 kkkk kkkk kkkk 0000 kkkk 0000 0110 kkkk kkkk kkkk kkkk kkkk 0100 kkkk kkkk kkkk 1001 kkkk 1000 0011 kkkk kkkk C,DC,Z Z TO,PD Z
TO,PD C,DC,Z Z
When an I/O register is modied as a function of itself ( e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1), the value used will be that value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is '1' for a pin congured as input and is driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a '0'. 2: If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and, where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if assigned to the Timer0 Module. 3: If Program Counter (PC) is modied or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second cycle is executed as a NOP.
DS30292A-page 152
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
14.0
14.1
DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
Development Tools
14.3
The PICmicr microcontrollers are supported with a full range of hardware and software development tools: MPLAB-ICE Real-Time In-Circuit Emulator ICEPIC Low-Cost PIC16C5X and PIC16CXXX In-Circuit Emulator PRO MATE II Universal Programmer PICSTART Plus Entry-Level Prototype Programmer SIMICE PICDEM-1 Low-Cost Demonstration Board PICDEM-2 Low-Cost Demonstration Board PICDEM-3 Low-Cost Demonstration Board MPASM Assembler MPLAB SIM Software Simulator MPLAB-C17 (C Compiler) Fuzzy Logic Development System (fuzzyTECHMP) KEELOQ Evaluation Kits and Programmer
ICEPIC is a low-cost in-circuit emulator solution for the Microchip PIC12CXXX, PIC16C5X and PIC16CXXX families of 8-bit OTP microcontrollers. ICEPIC is designed to operate on PC-compatible machines ranging from 386 through Pentium based machines under Windows 3.x, Windows 95, or Windows NT environment. ICEPIC features real time, nonintrusive emulation.
14.4
The PRO MATE II Universal Programmer is a full-featured programmer capable of operating in stand-alone mode as well as PC-hosted mode. PRO MATE II is CE compliant. The PRO MATE II has programmable VDD and VPP supplies which allows it to verify programmed memory at VDD min and VDD max for maximum reliability. It has an LCD display for displaying error messages, keys to enter commands and a modular detachable socket assembly to support various package types. In standalone mode the PRO MATE II can read, verify or program PIC12CXXX, PIC14C000, PIC16C5X, PIC16CXXX and PIC17CXX devices. It can also set conguration and code-protect bits in this mode.
14.2
The MPLAB-ICE Universal In-Circuit Emulator is intended to provide the product development engineer with a complete microcontroller design tool set for PICmicro microcontrollers (MCUs). MPLAB-ICE is supplied with the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment (IDE), which allows editing, make and download, and source debugging from a single environment. Interchangeable processor modules allow the system to be easily recongured for emulation of different processors. The universal architecture of the MPLAB-ICE allows expansion to support all new Microchip microcontrollers. The MPLAB-ICE Emulator System has been designed as a real-time emulation system with advanced features that are generally found on more expensive development tools. The PC compatible 386 (and higher) machine platform and Microsoft Windows 3.x or Windows 95 environment were chosen to best make these features available to you, the end user. MPLAB-ICE is available in two versions. MPLAB-ICE 1000 is a basic, low-cost emulator system with simple trace capabilities. It shares processor modules with the MPLAB-ICE 2000. This is a full-featured emulator system with enhanced trace, trigger, and data monitoring features. Both systems will operate across the entire operating speed reange of the PICmicro MCU.
14.5
The PICSTART programmer is an easy-to-use, lowcost prototype programmer. It connects to the PC via one of the COM (RS-232) ports. MPLAB Integrated Development Environment software makes using the programmer simple and efcient. PICSTART Plus is not recommended for production programming. PICSTART Plus supports all PIC12CXXX, PIC14C000, PIC16C5X, PIC16CXXX and PIC17CXX devices with up to 40 pins. Larger pin count devices such as the PIC16C923, PIC16C924 and PIC17C756 may be supported with an adapter socket. PICSTART Plus is CE compliant.
14.6
SIMICE is an entry-level hardware development system designed to operate in a PC-based environment with Microchips simulator MPLAB-SIM. Both SIMICE and MPLAB-SIM run under Microchip Technologys MPLAB Integrated Development Environment (IDE) software. Specically, SIMICE provides hardware simulation for Microchips PIC12C5XX, PIC12CE5XX, and PIC16C5X families of PICmicro 8-bit microcontrollers. SIMICE works in conjunction with MPLAB-SIM to provide non-real-time I/O port emulation. SIMICE enables a developer to run simulator code for driving the target system. In addition, the target system can
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 153
PIC16F87X
provide input to the simulator code. This capability allows for simple and interactive debugging without having to manually generate MPLAB-SIM stimulus les. SIMICE is a valuable debugging tool for entrylevel system development. mer or PICSTART Plus with an adapter socket, and easily test rmware. The MPLAB-ICE emulator may also be used with the PICDEM-3 board to test rmware. Additional prototype area has been provided to the user for adding hardware and connecting it to the microcontroller socket(s). Some of the features include an RS-232 interface, push-button switches, a potentiometer for simulated analog input, a thermistor and separate headers for connection to an external LCD module and a keypad. Also provided on the PICDEM-3 board is an LCD panel, with 4 commons and 12 segments, that is capable of displaying time, temperature and day of the week. The PICDEM-3 provides an additional RS-232 interface and Windows 3.1 software for showing the demultiplexed LCD signals on a PC. A simple serial interface allows the user to construct a hardware demultiplexer for the LCD signals.
14.7
The PICDEM-1 is a simple board which demonstrates the capabilities of several of Microchips microcontrollers. The microcontrollers supported are: PIC16C5X (PIC16C54 to PIC16C58A), PIC16C61, PIC16C62X, PIC16C71, PIC16C8X, PIC17C42, PIC17C43 and PIC17C44. All necessary hardware and software is included to run basic demo programs. The users can program the sample microcontrollers provided with the PICDEM-1 board, on a PRO MATE II or PICSTART-Plus programmer, and easily test rmware. The user can also connect the PICDEM-1 board to the MPLAB-ICE emulator and download the rmware to the emulator for testing. Additional prototype area is available for the user to build some additional hardware and connect it to the microcontroller socket(s). Some of the features include an RS-232 interface, a potentiometer for simulated analog input, push-button switches and eight LEDs connected to PORTB.
14.10
The MPLAB IDE Software brings an ease of software development previously unseen in the 8-bit microcontroller market. MPLAB is a windows based application which contains: A full featured editor Three operating modes - editor - emulator - simulator A project manager Customizable tool bar and key mapping A status bar with project information Extensive on-line help MPLAB allows you to: Edit your source les (either assembly or C) One touch assemble (or compile) and download to PICmicro tools (automatically updates all project information) Debug using: - source les - absolute listing le The ability to use MPLAB with Microchips simulator allows a consistent platform and the ability to easily switch from the low cost simulator to the full featured emulator with minimal retraining due to development tools.
14.8
The PICDEM-2 is a simple demonstration board that supports the PIC16C62, PIC16C64, PIC16C65, PIC16C73 and PIC16C74 microcontrollers. All the necessary hardware and software is included to run the basic demonstration programs. The user can program the sample microcontrollers provided with the PICDEM-2 board, on a PRO MATE II programmer or PICSTART-Plus, and easily test rmware. The MPLAB-ICE emulator may also be used with the PICDEM-2 board to test rmware. Additional prototype area has been provided to the user for adding additional hardware and connecting it to the microcontroller socket(s). Some of the features include a RS-232 interface, push-button switches, a potentiometer for simulated analog input, a Serial EEPROM to demonstrate usage of the I2C bus and separate headers for connection to an LCD module and a keypad.
14.9
14.11
Assembler (MPASM)
The PICDEM-3 is a simple demonstration board that supports the PIC16C923 and PIC16C924 in the PLCC package. It will also support future 44-pin PLCC microcontrollers with a LCD Module. All the necessary hardware and software is included to run the basic demonstration programs. The user can program the sample microcontrollers provided with the PICDEM-3 board, on a PRO MATE II program-
The MPASM Universal Macro Assembler is a PChosted symbolic assembler. It supports all microcontroller series including the PIC12C5XX, PIC14000, PIC16C5X, PIC16CXXX, and PIC17CXX families. MPASM offers full featured Macro capabilities, conditional assembly, and several source and listing formats. It generates various object code formats to support Microchip's development tools as well as third party programmers.
DS30292A-page 154
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
MPASM allows full symbolic debugging from MPLABICE, Microchips Universal Emulator System. MPASM has the following features to assist in developing software for specic use applications. Provides translation of Assembler source code to object code for all Microchip microcontrollers. Macro assembly capability. Produces all the les (Object, Listing, Symbol, and special) required for symbolic debug with Microchips emulator systems. Supports Hex (default), Decimal and Octal source and listing formats. MPASM provides a rich directive language to support programming of the PICmicro. Directives are helpful in making the development of your assemble source code shorter and more maintainable.
14.15
The SEEVAL SEEPROM Designers Kit supports all Microchip 2-wire and 3-wire Serial EEPROMs. The kit includes everything necessary to read, write, erase or program special features of any Microchip SEEPROM product including Smart Serials and secure serials. The Total Endurance Disk is included to aid in tradeoff analysis and reliability calculations. The total kit can signicantly reduce time-to-market and result in an optimized system.
14.16
14.12
The MPLAB-SIM Software Simulator allows code development in a PC host environment. It allows the user to simulate the PICmicro series microcontrollers on an instruction level. On any given instruction, the user may examine or modify any of the data areas or provide external stimulus to any of the pins. The input/ output radix can be set by the user and the execution can be performed in; single step, execute until break, or in a trace mode. MPLAB-SIM fully supports symbolic debugging using MPLAB-C17 and MPASM. The Software Simulator offers the low cost exibility to develop and debug code outside of the laboratory environment making it an excellent multi-project software development tool.
KEELOQ evaluation and programming tools support Microchips HCS Secure Data Products. The HCS evaluation kit includes an LCD display to show changing codes, a decoder to decode transmissions, and a programming interface to program test transmitters.
14.13
MPLAB-C17 Compiler
The MPLAB-C17 Code Development System is a complete ANSI C compiler and integrated development environment for Microchips PIC17CXXX family of microcontrollers. The compiler provides powerful integration capabilities and ease of use not found with other compilers. For easier source level debugging, the compiler provides symbol information that is compatible with the MPLAB IDE memory display.
14.14
fuzzyTECH-MP fuzzy logic development tool is available in two versions - a low cost introductory version, MP Explorer, for designers to gain a comprehensive working knowledge of fuzzy logic system design; and a full-featured version, fuzzyTECH-MP, Edition for implementing more complex systems.
Both versions include Microchips fuzzyLAB demonstration board for hands-on experience with fuzzy logic systems implementation.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 155
Emulator Products
Software Tools
Programmers
Demo Boards
DS30292A-page 156
TABLE 14-1
PIC16F87X
PIC12C5XX
PIC14000
MPLAB-ICE
ICEPIC Low-Cost In-Circuit Emulator MPLAB Integrated Development Environment MPLAB C17* Compiler
fuzzyTECH-MP
Explorer/Edition Fuzzy Logic Dev. Tool Total Endurance Software Model PICSTARTPlus Low-Cost Universal Dev. Kit PRO MATE II Universal Programmer KEELOQ Programmer SEEVAL Designers Kit SIMICE PICDEM-14A PICDEM-1 PICDEM-2 PICDEM-3 KEELOQ Evaluation Kit KEELOQ Transponder Kit
Preliminary
1998 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16F87X
15.0 ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Absolute Maximum Ratings Ambient temperature under bias................................................................................................................ .-55 to +125C Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65C to +150C Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD, MCLR. and RA4).......................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V) Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ........................................................................................................... -0.3 to +7.5V Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS (Note 2)..................................................................................................0 to +14V Voltage on RA4 with respect to Vss ..................................................................................................................0 to +8.5V Total power dissipation (Note 1)................................................................................................................................1.0W Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA Maximum current into VDD pin ..............................................................................................................................250 mA Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)..................................................................................................................... 20 mA Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) ............................................................................................................. 20 mA Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin..........................................................................................................25 mA Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ....................................................................................................25 mA Maximum current sunk by PORTA, PORTB, and PORTE (combined) (Note 3)....................................................200 mA Maximum current sourced by PORTA, PORTB, and PORTE (combined) (Note 3) ..............................................200 mA Maximum current sunk by PORTC and PORTD (combined) (Note 3) ..................................................................200 mA Maximum current sourced by PORTC and PORTD (combined) (Note 3).............................................................200 mA Note 1: Power dissipation is calculated as follows: Pdis = VDD x {IDD - IOH} + {(VDD - VOH) x IOH} + (VOl x IOL) Note 2: Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up. Thus, a series resistor of 50-100 should be used when applying a low level to the MCLR pin rather than pulling this pin directly to VSS. Note 3: PORTD and PORTE are not implemented on the 28-pin devices. NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation listings of this specication is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 157
PIC16F87X
TABLE 15-1 CROSS REFERENCE OF DEVICE SPECS FOR OSCILLATOR CONFIGURATIONS AND FREQUENCIES OF OPERATION (COMMERCIAL DEVICES)
PIC16F873-04 PIC16F873-20 PIC16LF873-04 PIC16F874-04 PIC16F874-20 PIC16LF874-04 OSC PIC16F876-04 PIC16F876-20 PIC16LF876-04 PIC16F877-04 PIC16F877-20 PIC16LF877-04 VDD: 4.0V to 5.5V VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V VDD: 2.0V to 5.5V IDD: 5 mA max. IDD: 2.0 mA typ. IDD: 3.8 mA max. at 5.5V at 5.5V at 3.0V RC IPD: 16 A max. IPD: 1.5 A typ. IPD: 5 A max. at 3V at 4V at 4V Freq: 4 MHz max. Freq: 4 MHz max. Freq: 4 MHz max. VDD: 4.0V to 5.5V VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V VDD: 2.0V to 5.5V IDD: 5 mA max. IDD: 2.0 mA typ. IDD: 3.8 mA max. at 5.5V at 5.5V XT at 3.0V IPD: 16 A max. IPD: 1.5 A typ. IPD: 5 A max. at 3V at 4V at 4V Freq: 4 MHz max. Freq: 4 MHz max. Freq: 4 MHz max. VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V VDD: 4.5V to 5.5V IDD: 13.5 mA typ. IDD: 20 mA max. at 5.5V at 5.5V Not recommended for use in HS mode HS IPD: 1.5 A typ. IPD: 1.5 A typ. at 4.5V at 4.5V Freq: 4 MHz max. Freq: 20 MHz max. VDD: 4.0V to 5.5V VDD: 2.0V to 5.5V IDD: 52.5 A typ. IDD: 48 A max. at 32 kHz, 4.0V at 32 kHz, 3.0V LP Not recommended for use in LP mode IPD: 0.9 A typ. IPD: 5.0 A max. at 4.0V at 3.0V Freq: 200 kHz max. Freq: 200 kHz max. The shaded sections indicate oscillator selections which are tested for functionality, but not for MIN/MAX specications. It is recommended that the user select the device type that ensures the specications required.
Note:
This is an advanced copy of the data sheet and therefore the contents and specications are subject to change based on device characterization.
DS30292A-page 158
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
15.1 DC Characteristics: PIC16F873/874/876/877-04 (Commercial, Industrial) PIC16F873/874/876/877-20 (Commercial, Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40C TA +85C for industrial and 0C TA +70C for commercial Sym VDD VDR Min 4.0 4.5 Typ Max Units 1.5 VSS 5.5 5.5 V V V V See section on Power-on Reset for details Conditions XT, RC and LP osc conguration HS osc conguration
D001 Supply Voltage D001A D002* D003 RAM Data Retention Voltage (Note 1)
VPOR VDD start voltage to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal VDD rise rate to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal Brown-out Reset Voltage SVDD
D004*
0.05
D005 D010
BVDD
3.7 -
4.0 2.0
4.3 5
V mA
BODEN bit in conguration word enabled XT, RC osc conguration FOSC = 4 MHz, VDD = 5.5V (Note 4) HS osc conguration FOSC = 20 MHz, VDD = 5.5V BOR enabled VDD = 5.0V VDD = 4.0V, WDT enabled, -40C to +85C VDD = 4.0V, WDT disabled, -0C to +70C VDD = 4.0V, WDT disabled, -40C to +85C VDD = 4.0V, WDT disabled, -40C to +125C BOR enabled VDD = 5.0V
20 200 42 16 19 19 200
mA A A A A A A
D020 Power-down Current D021 (Note 3,5) D021A D021B D023* * Note 1: 2: Brown-out Reset Current (Note 6)
IBOR
3: 4: 5: 6:
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered without losing RAM data. The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors such as I/O pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern, and temperature also have an impact on the current consumption. The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are: OSC1 = external square wave, from rail to rail; all I/O pins tristated, pulled to VDD MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specied. The power-down current in SLEEP mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in SLEEP mode, with all I/O pins in hi-impedance state and tied to VDD and VSS. For RC osc conguration, current through Rext is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated by the formula Ir = VDD/2Rext (mA) with Rext in kOhm. Timer1 oscillator (when enabled) adds approximately 20 A to the specication. This value is from characterization and is for design guidance only. This is not tested. The current is the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. This current should be added to the base IDD or IPD measurement.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 159
PIC16F87X
15.2 DC Characteristics: PIC16LF873/874/876/877-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40C TA +85C for industrial and 0C TA +70C for commercial Sym VDD VDR VPOR Min 2.0 Typ Max Units 1.5 VSS 5.5 V V V See section on Power-on Reset for details Conditions LP, XT, RC osc conguration (DC - 4 MHz)
DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. D001 D002* D003 Characteristic Supply Voltage RAM Data Retention Voltage (Note 1) VDD start voltage to ensure internal Poweron Reset signal VDD rise rate to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal Brown-out Reset Voltage Supply Current (Note 2,5)
D004*
SVDD
0.05
D005 D010
BVDD IDD
3.7 -
4.0 2.0
4.3 3.8
V mA A A A A A A
BODEN bit in conguration word enabled XT, RC osc conguration FOSC = 4 MHz, VDD = 3.0V (Note 4) LP osc conguration FOSC = 32 kHz, VDD = 3.0V, WDT disabled BOR enabled VDD = 5.0V VDD = 3.0V, WDT enabled, -40C to +85C VDD = 3.0V, WDT disabled, 0C to +70C VDD = 3.0V, WDT disabled, -40C to +85C BOR enabled VDD = 5.0V
D010A D015* D020 D021 D021A D023* * Note 1: 2: Brown-out Reset Current IBOR (Note 6) Power-down Current (Note 3,5) IPD
48 200 30 5 5 200
3: 4: 5: 6:
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered without losing RAM data. The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors such as I/O pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern, and temperature also have an impact on the current consumption. The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are: OSC1 = external square wave, from rail to rail; all I/O pins tristated, pulled to VDD MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specied. The power-down current in SLEEP mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in SLEEP mode, with all I/O pins in hi-impedance state and tied to VDD and VSS. For RC osc conguration, current through Rext is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated by the formula Ir = VDD/2Rext (mA) with Rext in kOhm. Timer1 oscillator (when enabled) adds approximately 20 A to the specication. This value is from characterization and is for design guidance only. This is not tested. The current is the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. This current should be added to the base IDD or IPD measurement.
DS30292A-page 160
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
15.3 DC Characteristics: PIC16F873/874/876/877-04 (Commercial, Industrial PIC16F873/874/876/877-20 (Commercial, Industrial) PIC16LF873/874/876/877-04 (Commercial, Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40C TA +85C for industrial and 0C TA +70C for commercial Operating voltage VDD range as described in DC spec Section 15.1 and Section 15.2. Sym Min Typ Max Units Conditions
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param No.
VIL VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS -0.5 VIH 2.0 0.25VDD + 0.8V 0.8VDD 0.8VDD 0.7VDD 0.9VDD 0.15VDD 0.8V 0.2VDD 0.2VDD 0.3VDD 0.3VDD 0.6 V V V V V V V For entire VDD range 4.5V VDD 5.5V
D030 D030A D031 with Schmitt Trigger buffer D032 MCLR, OSC1 (in RC mode) D033 OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP) Ports RC3 and RC4 D034 with Schmitt Trigger buffer D034A with SMBus Input High Voltage I/O ports D040 with TTL buffer D040A
VDD VDD
V V
D041 with Schmitt Trigger buffer D042 MCLR D042A OSC1 (XT, HS and LP) D043 OSC1 (in RC mode) Ports RC3 and RC4 D044 with Schmitt Trigger buffer D044A with SMBus D070 PORTB weak pull-up current Input Leakage Current (Notes 2, 3) D060 I/O ports D061 D063 * MCLR, RA4/T0CKI OSC1
V V V V
V For entire VDD range V for VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V A VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
IIL
1 5 5
A Vss VPIN VDD, Pin at hi-impedance A Vss VPIN VDD A Vss VPIN VDD, XT, HS and LP osc conguration
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in Typ column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: In RC oscillator conguration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the PIC16F87X be driven with external clock in RC mode. 2: The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specied levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages. 3: Negative current is dened as current sourced by the pin.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 161
PIC16F87X
DC CHARACTERISTICS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40C TA +85C for industrial and 0C TA +70C for commercial Operating voltage VDD range as described in DC spec Section 15.1 and Section 15.2. Sym Min Typ Max Units Conditions
VOL
V V V V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +85C IOL = 7.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +125C IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +85C IOL = 1.2 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +125C IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +85C IOH = -2.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +125C IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +85C IOH = -1.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40C to +125C RA4 pin
8.5
V V V V V
Open-Drain High Voltage Capacitive Loading Specs on Output Pins OSC2 pin All I/O pins and OSC2 (in RC mode) SCL, SDA in I2C mode Data EEPROM Memory Endurance VDD for read/write Erase/write cycle time Program FLASH Memory Endurance VDD for read VDD for erase/write VDD for erase/write
VOD
D100 D101 D102 D120 D121 D122 D130 D131 D132 D132a D133
4 -
pF pF pF
E/W 25C at 5V V Using EECON to read/write Vmin = min operating voltage ms E/W V V V 25C at 5V Vmin = min operating voltage using ICSP port using EECON to read/write, Vmin = min operating voltage
Erase/Write cycle time TPEW 4 10 ms These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in Typ column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: In RC oscillator conguration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the PIC16F87X be driven with external clock in RC mode. 2: The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specied levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages. 3: Negative current is dened as current sourced by the pin. *
DS30292A-page 162
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
15.4 Timing Parameter Symbology
The timing parameter symbols have been created following one of the following formats: 1. TppS2ppS 2. TppS T F Frequency Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings: pp cc CCP1 ck CLKOUT cs CS di SDI do SDO dt Data in io I/O port mc MCLR Uppercase letters and their meanings: S F Fall H High I Invalid (Hi-impedance) L Low I2C only AA BUF output access Bus free T Time 3. TCC:ST 4. Ts (I2C specications only) (I2C specications only)
osc rd rw sc ss t0 t1 wr
P R V Z High Low
TCC:ST (I2C specications only) CC HD Hold ST DAT DATA input hold STA START condition
SU STO
RL
CL
Pin VSS
CL
for all pins except OSC2, but including PORTD and PORTE outputs as ports for OSC2 output
Note: PORTD and PORTE are not implemented on the 28-pin devices.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 163
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-2: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING
Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
OSC1
1 2 3 3 4 4
CLKOUT
TABLE 15-2
Parameter No.
DC 4 MHz XT and RC osc mode DC 4 MHz HS osc mode (-04) DC 20 MHz HS osc mode (-20) DC 200 kHz LP osc mode Oscillator Frequency DC 4 MHz RC osc mode (Note 1) 0.1 4 MHz XT osc mode 4 20 MHz HS osc mode 5 200 kHz LP osc mode 1 Tosc External CLKIN Period 250 ns XT and RC osc mode (Note 1) 250 ns HS osc mode (-04) 50 ns HS osc mode (-20) 5 s LP osc mode Oscillator Period 250 ns RC osc mode (Note 1) 250 10,000 ns XT osc mode 250 250 ns HS osc mode (-04) 50 250 ns HS osc mode (-20) 5 s LP osc mode 200 TCY DC ns TCY = 4/FOSC 2 TCY Instruction Cycle Time (Note 1) 3 TosL, External Clock in (OSC1) High or 100 ns XT oscillator TosH Low Time 2.5 s LP oscillator 15 ns HS oscillator 4 TosR, External Clock in (OSC1) Rise or 25 ns XT oscillator TosF Fall Time 50 ns LP oscillator 15 ns HS oscillator Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time-base period. All specied values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specied limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at "min." values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKIN pin. When an external clock input is used, the "Max." cycle time limit is "DC" (no clock) for all devices.
DS30292A-page 164
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-3: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING
Q4 OSC1 10 CLKOUT 13 14 I/O Pin (input) 17 I/O Pin (output) old value 20, 21 Note: Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions. 15 new value 19 18 12 16 11 Q1 Q2 Q3
TABLE 15-3
Param Sym No. 10* 11* 12* 13* 14* 15* 16* 17* 18*
TosH2ckL OSC1 to CLKOUT TosH2ckH OSC1 to CLKOUT TckR TckF TckL2ioV TckH2ioI CLKOUT rise time CLKOUT fall time CLKOUT to Port out valid Port in hold after CLKOUT
TioV2ckH Port in valid before CLKOUT TosH2ioV OSC1 (Q1 cycle) to Port out valid TosH2ioI OSC1 (Q2 cycle) to Port input invalid (I/O in hold time) Port output rise time Port output fall time INT pin high or low time RB7:RB4 change INT high or low time
TioV2osH Port input valid to OSC1 (I/O in setup time) TioR TioF Tinp Trbp Standard (F) Extended (LF) Standard (F) Extended (LF)
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges. Note 1: Measurements are taken in RC Mode where CLKOUT output is 4 x TOSC.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 165
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-4: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP TIMER TIMING
VDD MCLR Internal POR 33 PWRT Time-out OSC Time-out Internal RESET Watchdog Timer RESET 34 I/O Pins 32 30
31 34
VDD
BVDD 35
TABLE 15-4
Parameter No. 30 31* 32 33* 34 35 *
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER, AND BROWN-OUT RESET REQUIREMENTS
Sym TmcL Twdt Tost Tpwrt TIOZ TBOR Characteristic MCLR Pulse Width (low) Watchdog Timer Time-out Period (No Prescaler) Oscillation Start-up Timer Period Power up Timer Period I/O Hi-impedance from MCLR Low or Watchdog Timer Reset Brown-out Reset pulse width Min 2 7 28 100 Typ 18 1024TOSC 72 Max 33 132 2.1 Units s ms ms s s VDD BVDD (D005) Conditions VDD = 5V, -40C to +125C VDD = 5V, -40C to +125C TOSC = OSC1 period VDD = 5V, -40C to +125C
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
DS30292A-page 166
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-6: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS
RA4/T0CKI
40 42
41
RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI
45 47 TMR0 or TMR1
Note: Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions.
46 48
TABLE 15-5
Param No. 40* 41* 42* Sym Tt0H Tt0L
45*
46*
47*
48
0.5TCY + 20 10 Tt0P T0CKI Period TCY + 40 No Prescaler With Prescaler Greater of: 20 or TCY + 40 N Tt1H T1CKI High Time Synchronous, Prescaler = 1 0.5TCY + 20 Synchronous, PIC16F7X 15 Prescaler = PIC16LF7X 25 2,4,8 Asynchronous PIC16F7X 30 PIC16LF7X 50 Tt1L T1CKI Low Time Synchronous, Prescaler = 1 0.5TCY + 20 Synchronous, PIC16F7X 15 Prescaler = PIC16LF7X 25 2,4,8 Asynchronous PIC16F7X 30 PIC16LF7X 50 Tt1P T1CKI input period Synchronous PIC16F7X Greater of: 30 OR TCY + 40 N Greater of: PIC16LF7X 50 OR TCY + 40 N Asynchronous PIC16F7X 60 PIC16LF7X 100 Ft1 Timer1 oscillator input frequency range DC (oscillator enabled by setting bit T1OSCEN) TCKEZtmr1 Delay from external clock edge to timer increment 2Tosc
ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
200 7Tosc
ns ns kHz
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 167
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-7: CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM TIMINGS (CCP1 AND CCP2)
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 and RC2/CCP1 (Capture Mode) 50 52 51
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 and RC2/CCP1 (Compare or PWM Mode) 53 Note: Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions. 54
TABLE 15-6
Param No. 50*
51*
No Prescaler
52* 53*
TccP CCP1 and CCP2 input period TccR CCP1 and CCP2 output rise time
54*
Standard(F) Extended(LF)
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
DS30292A-page 168
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-8: PARALLEL SLAVE PORT TIMING (40-PIN DEVICES ONLY)
RE2/CS
RE0/RD
RE1/WR
64
TABLE 15-7
Parameter No. 62
63*
TwrH2dtI
64
TrdL2dtV
65 *
TrdH2dtI
RD or CS to dataout invalid
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 169
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-9: SPI MASTER MODE TIMING (CKE = 0)
SS 70 SCK (CKP = 0) 71 72
78
79
SCK (CKP = 1) 79 78
80 SDO MSb 75, 76 SDI MSb IN 74 73 Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions. BIT6 - - - -1
BIT6 - - - - - -1
LSb
LSb IN
SDO
MSb 75, 76
BIT6 - - - - - -1
LSb
SDI
MSb IN 74
BIT6 - - - -1
LSb IN
DS30292A-page 170
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-11: SPI SLAVE MODE TIMING (CKE = 0)
SS 70 SCK (CKP = 0) 71 72 83
78
79
SCK (CKP = 1) 79 78
80 SDO MSb 75, 76 SDI MSb IN 74 73 Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions. BIT6 - - - -1
BIT6 - - - - - -1
LSb 77 LSb IN
SCK (CKP = 0)
70 83 71 72
SCK (CKP = 1) 80
SDO
MSb 75, 76
BIT6 - - - - - -1
LSb 77
SDI
MSb IN 74
BIT6 - - - -1
LSb IN
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 171
PIC16F87X
TABLE 15-8
Parameter No. 70* 71* 72* 73* 74* 75* 76* 77* 78* 79* 80* 81* 82* 83*
TscH2ssH, 1.5TCY + 40 ns TscL2ssH These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in "Typ" column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
SCL 90 SDA
91 92
93
STOP Condition
TABLE 15-9
Parameter No. 90 91 92 93
ns ns ns ns
DS30292A-page 172
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-14: I2C BUS DATA TIMING
103 100 101 102
SCL
90 91 106 107 92
SDA In
110 109 109
TABLE 15-10
Parameter No. 100
Sym THIGH
101
TLOW
s s
102
TR
ns ns ns ns s s s s ns s ns ns s s ns ns s s
Cb is specied to be from 10 to 400 pF Cb is specied to be from 10 to 400 pF Only relevant for repeated START condition After this period the rst clock pulse is generated
103
TF
SDA and SCL fall time 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode START condition setup time START condition hold time Data input hold time Data input setup time STOP condition setup time Output valid from clock Bus free time 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode
Note 2
Note 1 Time the bus must be free before a new transmission can start
Cb Bus capacitive loading 400 pF Note 1: As a transmitter, the device must provide this internal minimum delay time to bridge the undened region (min. 300 ns) of the falling edge of SCL to avoid unintended generation of START or STOP conditions. 2: A fast-mode (400 kHz) I2C-bus device can be used in a standard-mode (100 kHz) I2C-bus system, but the requirement tsu;DAT 250 ns must then be met. This will automatically be the case if the device does not stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal. If such a device does stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal, it must output the next data bit to the SDA line TR max.+tsu;DAT = 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (according to the standard-mode I2C bus specication) before the SCL line is released.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 173
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-15: USART SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (MASTER/SLAVE) TIMING
121 121
120 122
Note: Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions.
TABLE 15-11
Param No. 120 Sym
TckH2dtV
121 122 :
Tckrf Tdtrf
Clock out rise time and fall time Standard(F) (Master Mode) Extended(LF) Data out rise time and fall time Standard(F) Extended(LF)
Data in Typ column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
125
126
Note: Refer to Figure 15-1 for load conditions.
TABLE 15-12
Parameter No. 125 126 :
15 15
ns ns
Data in Typ column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
DS30292A-page 174
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
TABLE 15-13 PIC16F873/874/876/877-04 (COMMERCIAL, INDUSTRIAL) PIC16F873/874/876/877-20 (COMMERCIAL, INDUSTRIAL) PIC16LF873/874/876/877-04 (COMMERCIAL, INDUSTRIAL)
Characteristic Resolution Integral linearity error Differential linearity error Offset error Gain error Monotonicity Reference voltage (VREF+ - VREF-) Min 2.0V Typ guaranteed Max 10-bits <1 <1 <1 <1 VDD + 0.3 Units bit Conditions VREF = VDD = 5.12V, VSS VAIN VREF
LSb VREF = VDD = 5.12V, VSS VAIN VREF LSb VREF = VDD = 5.12V, VSS VAIN VREF LSb VREF = VDD = 5.12V, VSS VAIN VREF LSb VREF = VDD = 5.12V, VSS VAIN VREF V VSS VAIN VREF Absolute minimum electrical spec. To ensure 10-bit accuracy.
VREF+ Reference voltage High VREF- Reference voltage low VAIN ZAIN IAD Analog input voltage Recommended impedance of analog voltage source A/D conversion current (VDD) Standard Extended
V V V k A A A Average current consumption when A/D is on. (Note 1) During VAIN acquisition. Based on differential of VHOLD to VAIN to charge CHOLD, see Section 10.1. During A/D Conversion cycle
A50
IREF
10
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in Typ column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: When A/D is off, it will not consume any current other than minor leakage current. The power-down current spec includes any such leakage from the A/D module. 2: VREF current is from RA3 pin or VDD pin, whichever is selected as reference input.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 175
PIC16F87X
FIGURE 15-17: A/D CONVERSION TIMING
1 TCY
A/D DATA
...
...
ADRES
OLD_DATA
NEW_DATA
ADIF GO DONE
SAMPLE
SAMPLING STOPPED
Note 1:
If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed.
TABLE 15-14
Param No. 130
131 132
TCNV Conversion time (not including S/H time) (Note 1) TACQ Acquisition time
134
TGO
TOSC/2
These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in Typ column is at 5V, 25C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. This specication ensured by design. Note 1: ADRES register may be read on the following TCY cycle. 2: See Section 10.1 for min conditions.
DS30292A-page 176
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
16.0 DC AND AC CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS AND TABLES
The graphs and tables provided in this section are for design guidance and are not tested. In some graphs or tables, the data presented are outside specied operating range (i.e., outside specied VDD range). This is for information only and devices are guaranteed to operate properly only within the specied range. The data presented in this section is a statistical summary of data collected on units from different lots over a period of time and matrix samples. 'Typical' represents the mean of the distribution at 25C. 'Max' or 'min' represents (mean + 3) or (mean - 3) respectively, where is standard deviation, over the whole temperature range. Graphs and Tables not available at this time.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 177
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 178
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
17.0
17.1
PACKAGING INFORMATION
Package Marking Information
D E Note:
Microchip part number information Customer specic information* Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year) Week code (week of January 1 is week 01) Facility code of the plant at which wafer is manufactured O = Outside Vendor C = 5 Line S = 6 Line H = 8 Line Mask revision number Assembly code of the plant or country of origin in which part was assembled
In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will be carried over to the next line thus limiting the number of available characters for customer specic information.
Standard OTP marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code, facility code, mask rev#, and assembly code. For OTP marking beyond this, certain price adders apply. Please check with your Microchip Sales Ofce. For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP price.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 179
PIC16F87X
Package Marking Information (Contd)
44-Lead PLCC
Example
DS30292A-page 180
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
17.2 K04-070 28-Lead Skinny Plastic Dual In-line (SP) 300 mil
E
2 n E1 A R eB Units Dimension Limits PCB Row Spacing Number of Pins Pitch Lower Lead Width Upper Lead Width Shoulder Radius Lead Thickness Top to Seating Plane Top of Lead to Seating Plane Base to Seating Plane Tip to Seating Plane Package Length Molded Package Width Radius to Radius Width Overall Row Spacing Mold Draft Angle Top Mold Draft Angle Bottom * Controlling Parameter.
A1
c A2 B1 B INCHES* NOM 0.300 28 0.100 0.019 0.016 0.053 0.040 0.005 0.000 0.010 0.008 0.150 0.140 0.090 0.070 0.020 0.015 0.130 0.125 1.365 1.345 0.288 0.280 0.270 0.283 0.320 0.350 5 10 5 10 p
MIN n p B B1 R c A A1 A2 L D E E1 eB
MAX
MIN
0.022 0.065 0.010 0.012 0.160 0.110 0.025 0.135 1.385 0.295 0.295 0.380 15 15
MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 7.62 28 2.54 0.48 0.41 0.56 1.33 1.02 1.65 0.13 0.00 0.25 0.25 0.20 0.30 3.81 3.56 4.06 2.29 1.78 2.79 0.51 0.38 0.64 3.30 3.18 3.43 34.67 34.16 35.18 7.11 7.30 7.49 6.86 7.18 7.49 8.13 8.89 9.65 5 10 15 5 10 15
Dimension B1 does not include dam-bar protrusions. Dam-bar protrusions shall not exceed 0.003 (0.076 mm) per side or 0.006 (0.152 mm) more than dimension B1. Dimensions D and E do not include mold ash or protrusions. Mold ash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 (0.254 mm) per side or 0.020 (0.508 mm) more than dimensions D or E.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 181
PIC16F87X
17.3 K04-052 28-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SO) Wide, 300 mil
E1 E p
B n X 45 c A L1 A2 INCHES* NOM 0.050 28 0.099 0.093 0.058 0.048 0.008 0.004 0.706 0.700 0.296 0.292 0.407 0.394 0.020 0.010 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.016 0.011 0 4 0.015 0.010 0.011 0.009 0.014 0.017 0 12 0 12 MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 1.27 28 2.36 2.50 2.64 1.22 1.47 1.73 0.10 0.19 0.28 17.78 17.93 18.08 7.42 7.51 7.59 10.01 10.33 10.64 0.50 0.74 0.25 0.13 0.13 0.25 0.13 0.25 0.13 0.28 0.41 0.53 8 0 4 0.25 0.38 0.51 0.23 0.27 0.30 0.36 0.42 0.48 0 12 15 0 12 15 A1 L R2 2 1
Units Dimension Limits Pitch Number of Pins Overall Pack. Height Shoulder Height Standoff Molded Package Length Molded Package Width Outside Dimension Chamfer Distance Shoulder Radius Gull Wing Radius Foot Length Foot Angle Radius Centerline Lead Thickness Lower Lead Width Mold Draft Angle Top Mold Draft Angle Bottom
*
R1
MIN p n A A1 A2 D E E1 X R1 R2 L L1 c B
MAX
MIN
0.104 0.068 0.011 0.712 0.299 0.419 0.029 0.010 0.010 0.021 8 0.020 0.012 0.019 15 15
Controlling Parameter. Dimension B does not include dam-bar protrusions. Dam-bar protrusions shall not exceed 0.003 (0.076 mm) per side or 0.006 (0.152 mm) more than dimension B. Dimensions D and E do not include mold ash or protrusions. Mold ash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 (0.254 mm) per side or 0.020 (0.508 mm) more than dimensions D or E.
DS30292A-page 182
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
17.4 K04-016 40-Lead Plastic Dual In-line (P) 600 mil
E
n E1
2 1
A1 A
R eB
c B1 A2 INCHES* NOM 0.600 40 0.100 0.018 0.016 0.050 0.045 0.005 0.000 0.010 0.009 0.160 0.110 0.073 0.093 0.020 0.020 0.125 0.130 2.013 2.018 0.530 0.535 0.565 0.545 0.630 0.610 5 10 10 5 B p
Units Dimension Limits PCB Row Spacing Number of Pins Pitch Lower Lead Width Upper Lead Width Shoulder Radius Lead Thickness Top to Seating Plane Top of Lead to Seating Plane Base to Seating Plane Tip to Seating Plane Package Length Molded Package Width Radius to Radius Width Overall Row Spacing Mold Draft Angle Top Mold Draft Angle Bottom * Controlling Parameter.
MIN n p B B1 R c A A1 A2 L D E E1 eB
MAX
MIN
0.020 0.055 0.010 0.011 0.160 0.113 0.040 0.135 2.023 0.540 0.585 0.670 15 15
MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 15.24 40 2.54 0.46 0.51 0.41 1.27 1.40 1.14 0.13 0.25 0.00 0.25 0.28 0.23 4.06 4.06 2.79 2.87 1.85 2.36 1.02 0.51 0.51 3.43 3.18 3.30 51.26 51.38 51.13 13.59 13.72 13.46 14.35 14.86 13.84 15.49 17.02 16.00 5 15 10 5 10 15
Dimension B1 does not include dam-bar protrusions. Dam-bar protrusions shall not exceed 0.003 (0.076 mm) per side or 0.006 (0.152 mm) more than dimension B1. Dimensions D and E do not include mold ash or protrusions. Mold ash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 (0.254 mm) per side or 0.020 (0.508 mm) more than dimensions D or E.
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 183
PIC16F87X
17.5 K04-076 44-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) 10x10x1 mm Body, 1.0/0.1 mm Lead Form
E1 E # leads = n1 p
D1
B n
2 1
X x 45 L R2 c L1 A
Units Dimension Limits Pitch Number of Pins Pins along Width Overall Pack. Height Shoulder Height Standoff Shoulder Radius Gull Wing Radius Foot Length Foot Angle Radius Centerline Lead Thickness Lower Lead Width Outside Tip Length Outside Tip Width Molded Pack. Length Molded Pack. Width Pin 1 Corner Chamfer Mold Draft Angle Top Mold Draft Angle Bottom
*
R1
A2 INCHES NOM 0.031 44 11 0.043 0.025 0.004 0.003 0.006 0.010 3.5 0.008 0.006 0.015 0.472 0.472 0.394 0.394 0.035 10 12
A1
MIN p n n1 A A1 A2 R1 R2 L L1 c B D1 E1 D E X
MAX
MIN
0.039 0.015 0.002 0.003 0.003 0.005 0 0.003 0.004 0.012 0.463 0.463 0.390 0.390 0.025 5 5
0.047 0.035 0.006 0.010 0.008 0.015 7 0.013 0.008 0.018 0.482 0.482 0.398 0.398 0.045 15 15
MILLIMETERS* NOM MAX 0.80 44 11 1.20 1.00 1.10 0.89 0.38 0.64 0.15 0.05 0.10 0.25 0.08 0.08 0.20 0.08 0.14 0.38 0.13 0.25 7 0 3.5 0.33 0.08 0.20 0.20 0.09 0.15 0.45 0.30 0.38 12.25 11.75 12.00 12.25 11.75 12.00 9.90 10.00 10.10 9.90 10.00 10.10 0.64 0.89 1.14 5 10 15 5 12 15
Controlling Parameter. Dimension B does not include dam-bar protrusions. Dam-bar protrusions shall not exceed 0.003 (0.076 mm) per side or 0.006 (0.152 mm) more than dimension B. Dimensions D and E do not include mold ash or protrusions. Mold ash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 (0.254 mm) per side or 0.020 (0.508 mm) more than dimensions D or E. JEDEC equivalent:MS-026 ACB
DS30292A-page 184
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
17.6 K04-071 44-Lead Plastic Quad Flatpack (PQ) 10x10x2 mm Body, 1.6/0.15 mm Lead Form
E1 E # leads = n1 p
D D1
2 1 B n
X x 45 L R2
c R1 L1
Units Dimension Limits Pitch Number of Pins Pins along Width Overall Pack. Height Shoulder Height Standoff Shoulder Radius Gull Wing Radius Foot Length Foot Angle Radius Centerline Lead Thickness Lower Lead Width Outside Tip Length Outside Tip Width Molded Pack. Length Molded Pack. Width Pin 1 Corner Chamfer Mold Draft Angle Top Mold Draft Angle Bottom
*
A2 MAX MIN
A1 MILLIMETERS* NOM MAX 0.80 44 11 2.35 2.18 2.00 1.41 1.11 0.81 0.25 0.15 0.05 0.25 0.13 0.13 0.38 0.13 0.30 0.64 0.38 0.51 7 0 3.5 0.53 0.28 0.41 0.23 0.18 0.13 0.45 0.30 0.37 13.45 12.95 13.20 13.45 12.95 13.20 9.90 10.00 10.10 9.90 10.00 10.10 0.635 0.89 1.143 5 10 15 5 12 15
MIN p n n1 A A1 A2 R1 R2 L L1 c B D1 E1 D E X
0.079 0.032 0.002 0.005 0.005 0.015 0 0.011 0.005 0.012 0.510 0.510 0.390 0.390 0.025 5 5
INCHES NOM 0.031 44 11 0.086 0.044 0.006 0.005 0.012 0.020 3.5 0.016 0.007 0.015 0.520 0.520 0.394 0.394 0.035 10 12
0.093 0.056 0.010 0.010 0.015 0.025 7 0.021 0.009 0.018 0.530 0.530 0.398 0.398 0.045 15 15
Controlling Parameter. Dimension B does not include dam-bar protrusions. Dam-bar protrusions shall not exceed 0.003 (0.076 mm) per side or 0.006 (0.152 mm) more than dimension B. Dimensions D and E do not include mold ash or protrusions. Mold ash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 (0.254 mm) per side or 0.020 (0.508 mm) more than dimensions D or E. JEDEC equivalent:MS-022 AB
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 185
PIC16F87X
17.7 K04-048 44-Lead Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier (L) Square
E1 E # leads = n1
D D1
n12 CH2 x 45 R1 A1 c R2 E2 Units Dimension Limits Number of Pins Pitch Overall Pack. Height Shoulder Height Standoff Side 1 Chamfer Dim. Corner Chamfer (1) Corner Chamfer (other) Overall Pack. Width Overall Pack. Length Molded Pack. Width Molded Pack. Length Footprint Width Footprint Length Pins along Width Lead Thickness Upper Lead Width Lower Lead Width Upper Lead Length Shoulder Inside Radius J-Bend Inside Radius Mold Draft Angle Top Mold Draft Angle Bottom
*
CH1 x 45 A
A3
35
A2
B1 B p D2
0.165 0.095 0.015 0.024 0.040 0.000 0.685 0.685 0.650 0.650 0.610 0.610 0.008 0.026 0.015 0.050 0.003 0.015 0 0
INCHES* NOM 44 0.050 0.173 0.103 0.023 0.029 0.045 0.005 0.690 0.690 0.653 0.653 0.620 0.620 11 0.010 0.029 0.018 0.058 0.005 0.025 5 5
MAX
MIN
0.180 0.110 0.030 0.034 0.050 0.010 0.695 0.695 0.656 0.656 0.630 0.630 0.012 0.032 0.021 0.065 0.010 0.035 10 10
MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 44 1.27 4.38 4.19 4.57 2.60 2.41 2.79 0.57 0.38 0.76 0.74 0.61 0.86 1.14 1.02 1.27 0.13 0.00 0.25 17.53 17.40 17.65 17.53 17.40 17.65 16.59 16.51 16.66 16.59 16.51 16.66 15.75 15.49 16.00 15.75 15.49 16.00 11 0.25 0.20 0.30 0.81 0.66 0.74 0.53 0.38 0.46 1.65 1.27 1.46 0.13 0.25 0.08 0.64 0.89 0.38 10 0 5 10 0 5
Controlling Parameter. Dimension B1 does not include dam-bar protrusions. Dam-bar protrusions shall not exceed 0.003 (0.076 mm) per side or 0.006 (0.152 mm) more than dimension B1. Dimensions D and E do not include mold ash or protrusions. Mold ash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010" (0.254 mm) per side or 0.020" (0.508 mm) more than dimensions D or E. JEDEC equivalent:MO-047 AC
DS30292A-page 186
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
APPENDIX A: REVISION HISTORY
Version A B Date 98 98 Revision Description This is a new data sheet. However, these devices are similar to the PIC16C7X devices found in the PIC16C7X Data Sheet (DS30390) Data Memory Map for PIC16F873/874, moved ADFM bit from ADCON1<5> to ADCON1<7>
TABLE B-1:
Difference
A/D Parallel Slave Port Packages
PIC16F877/874
8 channels, 10bits yes 40-pin PDIP, 40-pin windowed CERDIP, 44-pin TQFP, 44-pin MQFP, 44pin PLCC
TABLE C-1:
Characteristic
Pins Timers Interrupts Communication Frequency A/D CCP Program Memory RAM EEPROM data Other
PIC16F87X
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 187
PIC16F87X
NOTES:
DS30292A-page 188
Preliminary
PIC16F87X
A
A/D ................................................................................... 121 Accuracy/Error ......................................................... 130 ADCON0 Register .................................................... 121 ADCON1 Register .................................................... 122 ADIF bit .................................................................... 123 Analog Input Model Block Diagram .......................... 126 Analog Port Pins ...................................... 7, 8, 9, 37, 38 Block Diagram .......................................................... 124 Configuring Analog Port Pins ................................... 127 Configuring the Interrupt .......................................... 123 Configuring the Module ............................................ 123 Connection Considerations ...................................... 131 Conversion Clock ..................................................... 127 Conversions ............................................................. 128 Delays ...................................................................... 126 Effects of a Reset ..................................................... 130 Equations ................................................................. 126 Flowchart of A/D Operation ...................................... 129 GO/DONE bit ........................................................... 123 Internal Sampling Switch (Rss) Impedence ............. 125 Operation During Sleep ........................................... 129 Sampling Requirements ........................................... 125 Sampling Time ......................................................... 126 Source Impedence ................................................... 125 Special Event Trigger (CCP) ...................................... 57 Time Delays ............................................................. 126 Transfer Function ..................................................... 131 Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................. 157 ACK .................................................................................... 72 Acknowledge Data bit, AKD ............................................... 64 Acknowledge Pulse ............................................................ 72 Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit, AKE .......................... 64 Acknowledge Status bit, AKS ............................................ 64 ADRES Register ........................................................ 16, 121 AKD .................................................................................... 64 AKE .................................................................................... 64 AKS .............................................................................. 64, 87 Application Note AN578, "Use of the SSP Module in the I2C Multi-Master Environment." ................... 71 Architecture PIC16C63A/PIC16C73B Block Diagram ...................... 5 PIC16C65B/PIC16C74B Block Diagram ...................... 6 Assembler MPASM Assembler .................................................. 154 Bus Collision Section ....................................................................... 98 Bus Collision During a RESTART Condition ................... 101 Bus Collision During a Start Condition .............................. 99 Bus Collision During a Stop Condition ............................. 102 Bus Collision Interrupt Flag bit, BCLIF .............................. 25
C
Capture (CCP Module) ...................................................... 56 Block Diagram ........................................................... 56 CCP Pin Configuration .............................................. 56 CCPR1H:CCPR1L Registers .................................... 56 Changing Between Capture Prescalers .................... 56 Software Interrupt ...................................................... 56 Timer1 Mode Selection .............................................. 56 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) ......................................... 55 CCP1 ......................................................................... 55 CCP1CON Register .......................................... 55 CCPR1H Register ............................................. 55 CCPR1L Register .............................................. 55 RC2/CCP1 Pin ................................................ 7, 9 CCP2 ......................................................................... 55 CCP2CON Register .......................................... 55 CCPR2H Register ............................................. 55 CCPR2L Register .............................................. 55 RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 Pin ..................................... 7, 9 Interaction of Two CCP Modules ............................... 55 Timer Resources ....................................................... 55 CCP1CON ......................................................................... 18 CCP1CON Register ........................................................... 55 CCP1M3:CCP1M0 Bits ............................................. 55 CCP1X:CCP1Y Bits ................................................... 55 CCP2CON ......................................................................... 18 CCP2CON Register ........................................................... 55 CCP2M3:CCP2M0 Bits ............................................. 55 CCP2X:CCP2Y Bits ................................................... 55 CCPR1H Register ....................................................... 16, 18 CCPR1L Register .............................................................. 18 CCPR2H Register ....................................................... 16, 18 CCPR2L Register ........................................................ 16, 18 CKE ................................................................................... 62 CKP ................................................................................... 63 Clock Polarity Select bit, CKP ........................................... 63 Code Examples Loading the SSPBUF register ................................... 66 Code Protection ....................................................... 133, 148 Compare (CCP Module) .................................................... 57 Block Diagram ........................................................... 57 CCP Pin Configuration .............................................. 57 CCPR1H:CCPR1L Registers .................................... 57 Software Interrupt ...................................................... 57 Special Event Trigger .......................................... 51, 57 Timer1 Mode Selection .............................................. 57 Configuration Bits ............................................................ 133 Conversion Considerations ............................................. 187
B
Banking, Data Memory ................................................ 12, 19 Baud Rate Generator ......................................................... 81 BCLIF ................................................................................. 25 BF .................................................................... 62, 72, 87, 90 Block Diagrams A/D ........................................................................... 124 Analog Input Model .................................................. 126 Baud Rate Generator ................................................. 81 I2C Master Mode ........................................................ 79 I2C Module ................................................................. 71 SSP (I2C Mode) ......................................................... 71 SSP (SPI Mode) ......................................................... 65 BRG ................................................................................... 81 Brown-out Reset (BOR) ................... 133, 136, 138, 139, 140 BOR Status (BOR Bit) ................................................ 26 Buffer Full bit, BF ............................................................... 72 Buffer Full Status bit, BF .................................................... 62 Bus Arbitration ................................................................... 98
D
D/A ..................................................................................... 62 Data Memory ..................................................................... 12 Bank Select (RP1:RP0 Bits) ................................ 12, 19 General Purpose Registers ....................................... 12 Register File Map ...................................................... 13 Special Function Registers ........................................ 15 Data/Address bit, D/A ........................................................ 62
DS30292A-page 189
PIC16F87X
DC Characteristics PIC16C76 ................................................................ 159 PIC16C77 ................................................................ 159 Development Support ...................................................... 153 Development Tools .......................................................... 153 Device Differences ........................................................... 187 Direct Addressing ............................................................... 28 Master Mode Start Condition ..................................... 82 Master Mode Transmission ....................................... 87 Master Mode Transmit Sequence ............................. 80 Master Transmit Flowchart ........................................ 88 Multi-Master Communication ..................................... 98 Multi-master Mode ..................................................... 80 Operation ................................................................... 71 Repeat Start Condition timing .................................... 84 Restart Condition Flowchart ...................................... 85 Slave Mode ................................................................ 72 Slave Reception ........................................................ 73 Slave Transmission ................................................... 73 SSPBUF .................................................................... 72 Start Condition Flowchart .......................................... 83 Stop Condition Flowchart .......................................... 96 Stop Condition Receive or Transmit timing ............... 95 Stop Condition timing ................................................ 95 Waveforms for 7-bit Reception .................................. 73 Waveforms for 7-bit Transmission ............................. 74 I2C Module Address Register, SSPADD ........................... 72 I2C Slave Mode .................................................................. 72 ICEPIC Low-Cost PIC16CXXX In-Circuit Emulator ......... 153 ID Locations ............................................................. 133, 148 In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) ...................... 133, 148 INDF .................................................................................. 18 INDF Register .............................................................. 16, 17 Indirect Addressing ............................................................ 28 FSR Register ............................................................. 12 Instruction Format ............................................................ 151 Instruction Set .................................................................. 151 Summary Table ....................................................... 152 INTCON ............................................................................. 18 INTCON Register ............................................................... 21 GIE Bit ....................................................................... 21 INTE Bit ..................................................................... 21 INTF Bit ..................................................................... 21 PEIE Bit ..................................................................... 21 RBIE Bit ..................................................................... 21 RBIF Bit ............................................................... 21, 31 T0IE Bit ...................................................................... 21 T0IF Bit ...................................................................... 21 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) .............................................. 61 Internal Sampling Switch (Rss) Impedence ..................... 125 Interrupt Sources ..................................................... 133, 143 Block Diagram ......................................................... 144 Capture Complete (CCP) .......................................... 56 Compare Complete (CCP) ........................................ 57 Interrupt on Change (RB7:RB4 ) ............................... 31 RB0/INT Pin, External ..................................... 7, 8, 145 TMR0 Overflow .................................................. 48, 145 TMR1 Overflow .................................................... 49, 51 TMR2 to PR2 Match .................................................. 54 TMR2 to PR2 Match (PWM) ................................ 53, 58 USART Receive/Transmit Complete ....................... 105 Interrupts Bus Collision Interrupt ............................................... 25 Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt ............................. 23 Interrupts, Context Saving During .................................... 145 Interrupts, Enable Bits CCP1 Enable (CCP1IE Bit) ....................................... 56 Global Interrupt Enable (GIE Bit) ....................... 21, 143 Interrupt on Change (RB7:RB4) Enable (RBIE Bit) ........................................................... 21, 145 Peripheral Interrupt Enable (PEIE Bit) ....................... 21 RB0/INT Enable (INTE Bit) ........................................ 21 TMR0 Overflow Enable (T0IE Bit) ............................. 21
E
Electrical Characteristics .................................................. 157 Errata ................................................................................... 4 External Power-on Reset Circuit ...................................... 138
F
Firmware Instructions ....................................................... 151 Flowcharts Acknowledge .............................................................. 94 Master Receiver ......................................................... 91 Master Transmit ......................................................... 88 Restart Condition ....................................................... 85 Start Condition ........................................................... 83 Stop Condition ........................................................... 96 FSR Register .......................................................... 16, 17, 18 Fuzzy Logic Dev. System (fuzzyTECH-MP) .................. 155
G
GCE ................................................................................... 64 General Call Address Sequence ........................................ 77 General Call Address Support ........................................... 77 General Call Enable bit, GCE ............................................ 64
I
I/O Ports ............................................................................. 29 I2C ...................................................................................... 71 I2C Master Mode Receiver Flowchart ................................ 91 I2C Master Mode Reception ............................................... 90 I2C Master Mode Restart Condition ................................... 84 I2C Mode Selection ............................................................ 71 I2C Module Acknowledge Flowchart ............................................. 94 Acknowledge Sequence timing .................................. 93 Addressing ................................................................. 72 Baud Rate Generator ................................................. 81 Block Diagram ............................................................ 79 BRG Block Diagram ................................................... 81 BRG Reset due to SDA Collision ............................. 100 BRG Timing ............................................................... 81 Bus Arbitration ........................................................... 98 Bus Collision .............................................................. 98 Acknowledge ...................................................... 98 Restart Condition ............................................. 101 Restart Condition Timing (Case1) .................... 101 Restart Condition Timing (Case2) .................... 101 Start Condition ................................................... 99 Start Condition Timing ............................... 99, 100 Stop Condition ................................................. 102 Stop Condition Timing (Case1) ........................ 102 Stop Condition Timing (Case2) ........................ 102 Transmit Timing ................................................. 98 Bus Collision timing .................................................... 98 Clock Arbitration ......................................................... 97 Clock Arbitration Timing (Master Transmit) ............... 97 Conditions to not give ACK Pulse .............................. 72 General Call Address Support ................................... 77 Master Mode .............................................................. 79 Master Mode 7-bit Reception timing .......................... 92 Master Mode Operation ............................................. 80
DS30292A-page 190
PIC16F87X
Interrupts, Flag Bits CCP1 Flag (CCP1IF Bit) ...................................... 56, 57 Interrupt on Change (RB7:RB4) Flag (RBIF Bit) ..................................................... 21, 31, 145 RB0/INT Flag (INTF Bit) ............................................. 21 TMR0 Overflow Flag (T0IF Bit) .......................... 21, 145 Pinout Descriptions PIC16C63A/PIC16C73B ...............................................7 PIC16C65B/PIC16C74B ...............................................8 PIR1 Register .................................................................... 23 PIR2 Register .................................................................... 25 Pointer, FSR ...................................................................... 27 PORTA ...................................................................... 7, 8, 18 Analog Port Pins ...................................................... 7, 8 Initialization ................................................................ 29 PORTA Register ........................................................ 29 RA3:RA0 and RA5 Port Pins ..................................... 29 RA4/T0CKI Pin .................................................. 7, 8, 29 RA5/SS/AN4 Pin ...................................................... 7, 8 TRISA Register .......................................................... 29 PORTA Register ................................................................ 16 PORTB ...................................................................... 7, 8, 18 Initialization ................................................................ 31 PORTB Register ........................................................ 31 Pull-up Enable (RBPU Bit) ......................................... 20 RB0/INT Edge Select (INTEDG Bit) .......................... 20 RB0/INT Pin, External ..................................... 7, 8, 145 RB3:RB0 Port Pins .................................................... 31 RB7:RB4 Interrupt on Change ................................. 145 RB7:RB4 Interrupt on Change Enable (RBIE Bit) ........................................................... 21, 145 RB7:RB4 Interrupt on Change Flag (RBIF Bit) ..................................................... 21, 31, 145 RB7:RB4 Port Pins .................................................... 31 TRISB Register .......................................................... 31 PORTB Register ................................................................ 16 PORTC ...................................................................... 7, 9, 18 Block Diagram ........................................................... 33 Initialization ................................................................ 33 PORTC Register ........................................................ 33 RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI Pin ........................................... 7, 9 RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 Pin ............................................. 7, 9 RC2/CCP1 Pin ......................................................... 7, 9 RC3/SCK/SCL Pin ................................................... 7, 9 RC4/SDI/SDA Pin .................................................... 7, 9 RC5/SDO Pin .......................................................... 7, 9 RC6/TX/CK Pin ................................................ 7, 9, 106 RC7/RX/DT Pin ....................................... 7, 9, 106, 107 TRISC Register ................................................. 33, 105 PORTC Register ................................................................ 16 PORTD .................................................................... 9, 18, 38 Block Diagram ........................................................... 35 Parallel Slave Port (PSP) Function ............................ 35 PORTD Register ........................................................ 35 TRISD Register ......................................................... 35 PORTD Register ................................................................ 16 PORTE .......................................................................... 9, 18 Analog Port Pins .............................................. 9, 37, 38 Block Diagram ........................................................... 36 Input Buffer Full Status (IBF Bit) ................................ 36 Input Buffer Overflow (IBOV Bit) ................................ 36 Output Buffer Full Status (OBF Bit) ........................... 36 PORTE Register ........................................................ 36 PSP Mode Select (PSPMODE Bit) ................ 35, 36, 38 RE0/RD/AN5 Pin ............................................. 9, 37, 38 RE1/WR/AN6 Pin ............................................ 9, 37, 38 RE2/CS/AN7 Pin ............................................. 9, 37, 38 TRISE Register .......................................................... 36 PORTE Register ................................................................ 16
K
KeeLoq Evaluation and Programming Tools ................. 155
M
Master Clear (MCLR) ....................................................... 7, 8 MCLR Reset, Normal Operation .............. 136, 139, 140 MCLR Reset, SLEEP ............................... 136, 139, 140 Memory Organization Data Memory ............................................................. 12 Program Memory ....................................................... 11 MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software . 154 Multi-Master Communication ............................................. 98 Multi-Master Mode ............................................................. 80
O
OPCODE Field Descriptions ............................................ 151 OPTION ............................................................................. 18 OPTION_REG Register ..................................................... 20 INTEDG Bit ................................................................ 20 PS2:PS0 Bits ....................................................... 20, 47 PSA Bit ................................................................. 20, 47 RBPU Bit .................................................................... 20 T0CS Bit ............................................................... 20, 47 T0SE Bit ............................................................... 20, 47 OSC1/CLKIN Pin ............................................................. 7, 8 OSC2/CLKOUT Pin ......................................................... 7, 8 Oscillator Configuration ............................................ 133, 134 HS .................................................................... 134, 139 LP ..................................................................... 134, 139 RC ............................................................ 134, 135, 139 XT .................................................................... 134, 139 Oscillator, Timer1 ......................................................... 49, 51 Oscillator, WDT ................................................................ 146
P
P ......................................................................................... 62 Packaging ........................................................................ 179 Paging, Program Memory ............................................ 11, 27 Parallel Slave Port (PSP) ......................................... 9, 35, 38 Block Diagram ............................................................ 38 RE0/RD/AN5 Pin .............................................. 9, 37, 38 RE1/WR/AN6 Pin ............................................. 9, 37, 38 RE2/CS/AN7 Pin .............................................. 9, 37, 38 Read Waveforms ....................................................... 39 Select (PSPMODE Bit) .................................. 35, 36, 38 Write Waveforms ....................................................... 38 PCL Register .......................................................... 16, 17, 18 PCLATH Register .................................................. 16, 17, 18 PCON Register .................................................... 18, 26, 139 BOR Bit ...................................................................... 26 POR Bit ...................................................................... 26 PICDEM-1 Low-Cost PICmicro Demo Board ................... 154 PICDEM-2 Low-Cost PIC16CXX Demo Board ................ 154 PICDEM-3 Low-Cost PIC16CXXX Demo Board .............. 154 PICSTART Plus Entry Level Development System ...... 153 PIE1 Register ............................................................... 18, 22 PIE2 Register ............................................................... 18, 24
DS30292A-page 191
PIC16F87X
Postscaler, Timer2 Select (TOUTPS3:TOUTPS0 Bits) ............................ 53 Postscaler, WDT ................................................................ 47 Assignment (PSA Bit) .......................................... 20, 47 Block Diagram ............................................................ 48 Rate Select (PS2:PS0 Bits) ................................. 20, 47 Switching Between Timer0 and WDT ........................ 48 Power-on Reset (POR) .................... 133, 136, 138, 139, 140 Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ....................... 133, 138 POR Status (POR Bit) ................................................ 26 Power Control (PCON) Register .............................. 139 Power-down (PD Bit) ......................................... 19, 136 Power-on Reset Circuit, External ............................. 138 Power-up Timer (PWRT) ................................. 133, 138 Time-out (TO Bit) ............................................... 19, 136 Time-out Sequence .................................................. 139 Time-out Sequence on Power-up .................... 141, 142 PR2 .................................................................................... 18 PR2 Register ...................................................................... 17 Prescaler, Capture ............................................................. 56 Prescaler, Timer0 ............................................................... 47 Assignment (PSA Bit) .......................................... 20, 47 Block Diagram ............................................................ 48 Rate Select (PS2:PS0 Bits) ................................. 20, 47 Switching Between Timer0 and WDT ........................ 48 Prescaler, Timer1 ............................................................... 50 Select (T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0 Bits) .............................. 49 Prescaler, Timer2 ............................................................... 58 Select (T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0 Bits) .............................. 53 PRO MATE II Universal Programmer ............................ 153 Product Identification System ........................................... 199 Program Counter PCL Register .............................................................. 27 PCLATH Register .............................................. 27, 145 Reset Conditions ...................................................... 139 Program Memory ............................................................... 11 Interrupt Vector .......................................................... 11 Paging .................................................................. 11, 27 Program Memory Map ............................................... 11 Reset Vector .............................................................. 11 Program Verification ......................................................... 148 Programming Pin (Vpp) .................................................... 7, 8 Programming, Device Instructions ................................... 151 PWM (CCP Module) ........................................................... 58 Block Diagram ............................................................ 58 CCPR1H:CCPR1L Registers ..................................... 58 Duty Cycle .................................................................. 58 Example Frequencies/Resolutions ............................ 59 Output Diagram .......................................................... 58 Period ......................................................................... 58 Set-Up for PWM Operation ........................................ 59 TMR2 to PR2 Match ............................................ 53, 58 RCSTA Register ........................................................ 18, 106 CREN Bit ................................................................. 106 FERR Bit .................................................................. 106 OERR Bit ................................................................. 106 RX9 Bit .................................................................... 106 RX9D Bit .................................................................. 106 SPEN Bit .......................................................... 105, 106 SREN Bit ................................................................. 106 Read/Write bit, R/W ........................................................... 62 Receive Overflow Indicator bit, SSPOV ............................. 63 Register File ....................................................................... 12 Register File Map ............................................................... 13 Registers FSR Summary ........................................................... 18 INDF Summary ........................................................... 18 INTCON Summary ........................................................... 18 OPTION Summary ........................................................... 18 PCL Summary ........................................................... 18 PCLATH Summary ........................................................... 18 PORTB Summary ........................................................... 18 SSPSTAT .................................................................. 62 STATUS Summary ........................................................... 18 Summary ................................................................... 16 TMR0 Summary ........................................................... 18 TRISB Summary ........................................................... 18 Reset ....................................................................... 133, 136 Block Diagram ......................................................... 137 Reset Conditions for All Registers ........................... 140 Reset Conditions for PCON Register ...................... 139 Reset Conditions for Program Counter ................... 139 Reset Conditions for STATUS Register .................. 139 WDT Reset. See Watchdog Timer (WDT) Restart Condition Enabled bit, RSE ................................... 64 Revision History ............................................................... 187 RSE ................................................................................... 64
S
S ........................................................................................ 62 SAE .................................................................................... 64 SCK ................................................................................... 65 SCL .................................................................................... 72 SDA ................................................................................... 72 SDI ..................................................................................... 65 SDO ................................................................................... 65 SEEVAL Evaluation and Programming System ............ 155 Serial Clock, SCK .............................................................. 65 Serial Clock, SCL ............................................................... 72 Serial Data Address, SDA ................................................. 72 Serial Data In, SDI ............................................................. 65 Serial Data Out, SDO ........................................................ 65 Slave Select Synchronization ............................................ 68 Slave Select, SS ................................................................ 65 SLEEP ............................................................. 133, 136, 147 SMP ................................................................................... 62 Software Simulator (MPLAB-SIM) ................................... 155 SPBRG .............................................................................. 18
Q
Q-Clock .............................................................................. 58
R
R/W .................................................................................... 62 R/W bit ............................................................................... 72 R/W bit ............................................................................... 73 RCE,Receive Enable bit, RCE ........................................... 64 RCREG .............................................................................. 18
DS30292A-page 192
PIC16F87X
SPBRG Register ................................................................ 17 SPE .................................................................................... 64 Special Features of the CPU ........................................... 133 Special Function Registers ................................................ 15 PIC16C73 .................................................................. 16 PIC16C73A ................................................................ 16 PIC16C74 .................................................................. 16 PIC16C74A ................................................................ 16 PIC16C76 .................................................................. 16 PIC16C77 .................................................................. 16 Speed, Operating ................................................................. 1 SPI Master Mode .............................................................. 67 Serial Clock ................................................................ 65 Serial Data In ............................................................. 65 Serial Data Out .......................................................... 65 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ................................ 61 Slave Select ............................................................... 65 SPI clock .................................................................... 67 SPI Mode ................................................................... 65 SPI Clock Edge Select, CKE ............................................. 62 SPI Data Input Sample Phase Select, SMP ...................... 62 SPI Master/Slave Connection ............................................ 66 SPI Module Master/Slave Connection ........................................... 66 Slave Mode ................................................................ 68 Slave Select Synchronization .................................... 68 Slave Synch Timnig ................................................... 68 SS ...................................................................................... 65 SSP .................................................................................... 61 Block Diagram (SPI Mode) ........................................ 65 RA5/SS/AN4 Pin ...................................................... 7, 8 RC3/SCK/SCL Pin ................................................... 7, 9 RC4/SDI/SDA Pin .................................................... 7, 9 RC5/SDO Pin ........................................................... 7, 9 SPI Mode ................................................................... 65 SSPADD .................................................................... 72 SSPBUF ............................................................... 67, 72 SSPCON1 .................................................................. 63 SSPCON2 .................................................................. 64 SSPSR ................................................................. 67, 72 SSPSTAT ............................................................. 62, 72 TMR2 Output for Clock Shift ................................ 53, 54 SSP I2C SSP I2C Operation ..................................................... 71 SSP Module SPI Master Mode ....................................................... 67 SPI Master./Slave Connection ................................... 66 SPI Slave Mode ......................................................... 68 SSPCON1 Register ................................................... 71 SSP Overflow Detect bit, SSPOV ...................................... 72 SSPADD Register ........................................................ 17, 18 SSPBUF ....................................................................... 18, 72 SSPBUF Register .............................................................. 16 SSPCON Register ............................................................. 16 SSPCON1 .................................................................... 63, 71 SSPCON2 .......................................................................... 64 SSPEN ............................................................................... 63 SSPIF ........................................................................... 23, 73 SSPM3:SSPM0 .................................................................. 63 SSPOV ................................................................... 63, 72, 90 SSPSTAT ..................................................................... 62, 72 SSPSTAT Register ...................................................... 17, 18 Stack .................................................................................. 27 Start bit (S) ........................................................................ 62 Start Condition Enabled bit, SAE ....................................... 64 STATUS Register ................................................ 18, 19, 145 C Bit ........................................................................... 19 DC Bit ........................................................................ 19 IRP Bit ....................................................................... 19 PD Bit ................................................................ 19, 136 RP1:RP0 Bits ............................................................. 19 TO Bit ................................................................ 19, 136 Z Bit ........................................................................... 19 Stop bit (P) ......................................................................... 62 Stop Condition Enable bit .................................................. 64 Synchronous Serial Port .................................................... 61 Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit, SSPEN ..................... 63 Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt ..................................... 23 Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits, SSPM3:SSPM0 ................................................................. 63
T
T1CON .............................................................................. 18 T1CON Register .......................................................... 18, 49 T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0 Bits ........................................... 49 T1OSCEN Bit ............................................................ 49 T1SYNC Bit ............................................................... 49 TMR1CS Bit ............................................................... 49 TMR1ON Bit .............................................................. 49 T2CON Register .......................................................... 18, 53 T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0 Bits ........................................... 53 TMR2ON Bit .............................................................. 53 TOUTPS3:TOUTPS0 Bits ......................................... 53 TAD .................................................................................. 127 Timer0 ............................................................................... 47 Block Diagram ........................................................... 47 Clock Source Edge Select (T0SE Bit) ................. 20, 47 Clock Source Select (T0CS Bit) .......................... 20, 47 Overflow Enable (T0IE Bit) ........................................ 21 Overflow Flag (T0IF Bit) .................................... 21, 145 Overflow Interrupt .............................................. 48, 145 RA4/T0CKI Pin, External Clock ............................... 7, 8 Timer1 ............................................................................... 49 Block Diagram ........................................................... 50 Capacitor Selection ................................................... 51 Clock Source Select (TMR1CS Bit) ........................... 49 External Clock Input Sync (T1SYNC Bit) ................... 49 Module On/Off (TMR1ON Bit) ................................... 49 Oscillator .............................................................. 49, 51 Oscillator Enable (T1OSCEN Bit) .............................. 49 Overflow Interrupt ................................................ 49, 51 RC0/T1OSO/T1CKI Pin ........................................... 7, 9 RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 Pin ............................................. 7, 9 Special Event Trigger (CCP) ............................... 51, 57 T1CON Register ........................................................ 49 TMR1H Register ........................................................ 49 TMR1L Register ........................................................ 49 Timer2 Block Diagram ........................................................... 54 PR2 Register ....................................................... 53, 58 SSP Clock Shift ................................................... 53, 54 T2CON Register ........................................................ 53 TMR2 Register .......................................................... 53 TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt ........................ 53, 54, 58
DS30292A-page 193
PIC16F87X
Timing Diagrams A/D Conversion ........................................................ 176 Acknowledge Sequence Timing ................................. 93 Baud Rate Generator with Clock Arbitration .............. 81 BRG Reset Due to SDA Collision ............................ 100 Brown-out Reset ...................................................... 166 Bus Collision Start Condition Timing ....................................... 99 Bus Collision During a Restart Condition (Case 1) .. 101 Bus Collision During a Restart Condition (Case2) ... 101 Bus Collision During a Start Condition (SCL = 0) .... 100 Bus Collision During a Stop Condition ..................... 102 Bus Collision for Transmit and Acknowledge ............. 98 Capture/Compare/PWM ........................................... 168 CLKOUT and I/O ...................................................... 165 I2C Bus Data ............................................................ 173 I2C Bus Start/Stop bits ............................................. 172 I2C Master Mode First Start bit timing ........................ 82 I2C Master Mode Reception timing ............................ 92 I2C Master Mode Transmission timing ....................... 89 Master Mode Transmit Clock Arbitration .................... 97 Power-up Timer ....................................................... 166 Repeat Start Condition ............................................... 84 Reset ........................................................................ 166 Slave Synchronization ............................................... 68 Start-up Timer .......................................................... 166 Stop Condition Receive or Transmit .......................... 95 Time-out Sequence on Power-up .................... 141, 142 Timer0 ...................................................................... 167 Timer1 ...................................................................... 167 USART Asynchronous Master Transmission ........... 111 USART Synchronous Receive ................................. 174 USART Synchronous Reception .............................. 117 USART Synchronous Transmission ................ 116, 174 USART, Asynchronous Reception ........................... 113 Wake-up from SLEEP via Interrupt .......................... 148 Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 166 TMR0 ................................................................................. 18 TMR0 Register ................................................................... 16 TMR1H ............................................................................... 18 TMR1H Register ................................................................ 16 TMR1L ............................................................................... 18 TMR1L Register ................................................................. 16 TMR2 ................................................................................. 18 TMR2 Register ................................................................... 16 TRISA ................................................................................. 18 TRISA Register .................................................................. 17 TRISB ................................................................................. 18 TRISB Register .................................................................. 17 TRISC ................................................................................ 18 TRISC Register .................................................................. 17 TRISD ................................................................................ 18 TRISD Register .................................................................. 17 TRISE ................................................................................. 18 TRISE Register ............................................................ 17, 36 IBF Bit ........................................................................ 36 IBOV Bit ..................................................................... 36 OBF Bit ...................................................................... 36 PSPMODE Bit ................................................ 35, 36, 38 TXREG ............................................................................... 18 TXSTA ................................................................................ 18 TXSTA Register ............................................................... 105 BRGH Bit ......................................................... 105, 107 CSRC Bit ................................................................. 105 SYNC Bit ................................................................. 105 TRMT Bit ................................................................. 105 TX9 Bit ..................................................................... 105 TX9D Bit .................................................................. 105 TXEN Bit .................................................................. 105
U
UA ...................................................................................... 62 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART) Asynchronous Receiver Setting Up Reception ....................................... 112 Timing Diagram ............................................... 113 Update Address, UA .......................................................... 62 USART ............................................................................. 105 Asynchronous Mode ................................................ 110 Master Transmission ....................................... 111 Receive Block Diagram ................................... 113 Transmit Block Diagram .................................. 110 Baud Rate Generator (BRG) ................................... 107 Baud Rate Error, Calculating ........................... 107 Baud Rate Formula ......................................... 107 Baud Rates, Asynchronous Mode (BRGH=0) ........................................................ 108 Baud Rates, Asynchronous Mode (BRGH=1) .............................................. 109 Baud Rates, Synchronous Mode ..................... 108 High Baud Rate Select (BRGH Bit) ......... 105, 107 Sampling .......................................................... 107 Clock Source Select (CSRC Bit) ............................. 105 Continuous Receive Enable (CREN Bit) ................. 106 Framing Error (FERR Bit) ........................................ 106 Mode Select (SYNC Bit) .......................................... 105 Overrun Error (OERR Bit) ........................................ 106 RC6/TX/CK Pin ........................................................ 7, 9 RC7/RX/DT Pin ....................................................... 7, 9 RCSTA Register ...................................................... 106 Receive Data, 9th bit (RX9D Bit) ............................. 106 Receive Enable, 9-bit (RX9 Bit) ............................... 106 Serial Port Enable (SPEN Bit) ......................... 105, 106 Single Receive Enable (SREN Bit) .......................... 106 Synchronous Master Mode ...................................... 115 Reception ........................................................ 117 Transmission ................................................... 116 Synchronous Slave Mode ........................................ 118 Transmit Data, 9th Bit (TX9D) ................................. 105 Transmit Enable (TXEN Bit) .................................... 105 Transmit Enable, Nine-bit (TX9 Bit) ......................... 105 Transmit Shift Register Status (TRMT Bit) .............. 105 TXSTA Register ....................................................... 105
DS30292A-page 194
PIC16F87X
W
W Register ....................................................................... 145 Wake-up from SLEEP .............................................. 133, 147 Interrupts .......................................................... 139, 140 MCLR Reset ............................................................ 140 Timing Diagram ........................................................ 148 WDT Reset .............................................................. 140 Watchdog Timer (WDT) ........................................... 133, 146 Block Diagram .......................................................... 146 Enable (WDTE Bit) ................................................... 146 Programming Considerations .................................. 146 RC Oscillator ............................................................ 146 Time-out Period ....................................................... 146 WDT Reset, Normal Operation ................ 136, 139, 140 WDT Reset, SLEEP ................................. 136, 139, 140 Waveform for General Call Address Sequence ................. 77 WCOL .................................................. 63, 82, 87, 90, 93, 95 WCOL Status Flag ............................................................. 82 Write Collision Detect bit, WCOL ....................................... 63 WWW, On-Line Support ...................................................... 4
DS30292A-page 195
PIC16F87X
DS30292A-page 196
PIC16F87X
ON-LINE SUPPORT
Microchip provides on-line support on the Microchip World Wide Web (WWW) site. The web site is used by Microchip as a means to make les and information easily available to customers. To view the site, the user must have access to the Internet and a web browser, such as Netscape or Microsoft Explorer. Files are also available for FTP download from our FTP site.
Trademarks: The Microchip name, logo, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART, PICMASTER and PRO MATE are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. FlexROM, MPLAB and fuzzyLAB are trademarks and SQTP is a service mark of Microchip in the U.S.A. All other trademarks mentioned herein are the property of their respective companies.
DS30292A-page 197
PIC16F87X
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (602) 786-7578. Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this Data Sheet. To: RE: Technical Publications Manager Reader Response Total Pages Sent
From: Name Company Address City / State / ZIP / Country Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________ Application (optional): Would you like a reply? Device: PIC16F87X Questions: 1. What are the best features of this document? Y N Literature Number: DS30292A FAX: (______) _________ - _________
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you nd the organization of this data sheet easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the data sheet do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the data sheet could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
8. How would you improve our software, systems, and silicon products?
DS30292A-page 198
PIC16F87X
PIC16F87X PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales ofce. PART NO. Device -XX X /XX Package XXX Pattern Examples:
g) PIC16F877 -20/P 301 = Commercial temp., PDIP package, 4 MHz, normal VDD limits, QTP pattern #301. PIC16F876 - 04I/SO = Industrial temp., SOIC package, 200 kHz, Extended VDD limits. PIC16F877 - 04I/P = Industrial temp., PDIP package, 10MHz, normal VDD limits.
h) Device PIC16F87X(1), PIC16F87XT(2);VDD range 4.0V to 5.5V PIC16LF87X(1), PIC16LF87XT(2);VDD range 2.0V to 5.5V PIC16F87X(1), PIC16F87XT(2);VDD range 4.0V to 5.5V PIC16LF87X(1), PIC16LF87XT(2);VDD range 2.0V to 5.5V i)
Frequency Range
04 20 b(3) I
= 4 MHz = 20 MHz
Note 1:
C LC T b
Temperature Range
= 0C to = -40C to
70C +85C
(Commercial) (Industrial)
2:
= CMOS = Low Power CMOS = in tape and reel - SOIC, PLCC, MQFP, TQFP packages only. = blank
Package
PQ PT SO SP P L
= = = = = =
MQFP (Metric PQFP) TQFP (Thin Quad Flatpack) SOIC Skinny plastic dip PDIP PLCC
Pattern
* JW Devices are UV erasable and can be programmed to any device conguration. JW Devices meet the electrical requirement of each oscillator type (including LC devices).
Preliminary
DS30292A-page 199
M
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
Corporate Ofce
Microchip Technology Inc. 2355 West Chandler Blvd. Chandler, AZ 85224-6199 Tel: 602-786-7200 Fax: 602-786-7277 Technical Support: 602 786-7627 Web: http://www.microchip.com
AMERICAS (continued)
Toronto
Microchip Technology Inc. 5925 Airport Road, Suite 200 Mississauga, Ontario L4V 1W1, Canada Tel: 905-405-6279 Fax: 905-405-6253
ASIA/PACIFIC (continued)
Singapore
Microchip Technology Singapore Pte Ltd. 200 Middle Road #07-02 Prime Centre Singapore 188980 Tel: 65-334-8870 Fax: 65-334-8850
ASIA/PACIFIC
Hong Kong
Microchip Asia Pacic RM 3801B, Tower Two Metroplaza 223 Hing Fong Road Kwai Fong, N.T., Hong Kong Tel: 852-2-401-1200 Fax: 852-2-401-3431
Taiwan, R.O.C
Microchip Technology Taiwan 10F-1C 207 Tung Hua North Road Taipei, Taiwan, ROC Tel: 886-2-2717-7175 Fax: 886-2-2545-0139
Atlanta
Microchip Technology Inc. 500 Sugar Mill Road, Suite 200B Atlanta, GA 30350 Tel: 770-640-0034 Fax: 770-640-0307
Boston
Microchip Technology Inc. 5 Mount Royal Avenue Marlborough, MA 01752 Tel: 508-480-9990 Fax: 508-480-8575
EUROPE
United Kingdom
Arizona Microchip Technology Ltd. 505 Eskdale Road Winnersh Triangle Wokingham Berkshire, England RG41 5TU Tel: 44-1189-21-5858 Fax: 44-1189-21-5835
India
Microchip Technology Inc. India Liaison Ofce No. 6, Legacy, Convent Road Bangalore 560 025, India Tel: 91-80-229-0061 Fax: 91-80-229-0062
Chicago
Microchip Technology Inc. 333 Pierce Road, Suite 180 Itasca, IL 60143 Tel: 630-285-0071 Fax: 630-285-0075
Japan
Microchip Technology Intl. Inc. Benex S-1 6F 3-18-20, Shinyokohama Kohoku-Ku, Yokohama-shi Kanagawa 222-0033 Japan Tel: 81-45-471- 6166 Fax: 81-45-471-6122
France
Arizona Microchip Technology SARL Zone Industrielle de la Bonde 2 Rue du Buisson aux Fraises 91300 Massy, France Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20 Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Dallas
Microchip Technology Inc. 14651 Dallas Parkway, Suite 816 Dallas, TX 75240-8809 Tel: 972-991-7177 Fax: 972-991-8588
Dayton
Microchip Technology Inc. Two Prestige Place, Suite 150 Miamisburg, OH 45342 Tel: 937-291-1654 Fax: 937-291-9175
Korea
Microchip Technology Korea 168-1, Youngbo Bldg. 3 Floor Samsung-Dong, Kangnam-Ku Seoul, Korea Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Fax: 82-2-558-5934
Germany
Arizona Microchip Technology GmbH Gustav-Heinemann-Ring 125 D-81739 Mnchen, Germany Tel: 49-89-627-144 0 Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Detroit
Microchip Technology Inc. 42705 Grand River, Suite 201 Novi, MI 48375-1727 Tel: 248-374-1888 Fax: 248-374-2874
Italy
Arizona Microchip Technology SRL Centro Direzionale Colleoni Palazzo Taurus 1 V. Le Colleoni 1 20041 Agrate Brianza Milan, Italy Tel: 39-39-6899939 Fax: 39-39-6899883 10/27/98
Shanghai
Microchip Technology RM 406 Shanghai Golden Bridge Bldg. 2077 Yanan Road West, Hong Qiao District Shanghai, PRC 200335 Tel: 86-21-6275-5700 Fax: 86 21-6275-5060
Los Angeles
Microchip Technology Inc. 18201 Von Karman, Suite 1090 Irvine, CA 92612 Tel: 714-263-1888 Fax: 714-263-1338
New York
Microchip Technology Inc. 150 Motor Parkway, Suite 202 Hauppauge, NY 11788 Tel: 516-273-5305 Fax: 516-273-5335
San Jose
Microchip Technology Inc. 2107 North First Street, Suite 590 San Jose, CA 95131 Tel: 408-436-7950 Fax: 408-436-7955
Microchip received ISO 9001 Quality System certication for its worldwide headquarters, design, and wafer fabrication facilities in January, 1997. Our eld-programmable PICmicro 8-bit MCUs, KEELOQ code hopping devices, Serial EEPROMs, related specialty memory products and development systems conform to the stringent quality standards of the International Standard Organization (ISO).
Printed on recycled paper.
All rights reserved. 1998 Microchip Technology Incorporated. Printed in the USA. 12/98
Information contained in this publication regarding device applications and the like is intended for suggestion only and may be superseded by updates. No representation or warranty is given and no liability is assumed by Microchip Technology Incorporated with respect to the accuracy or use of such information, or infringement of patents or other intellectual property rights arising from such use or otherwise. Use of Microchips products as critical components in life support systems is not authorized except with express written approval by Microchip. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any intellectual property rights. The Microchip logo and name are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Inc. in the U.S.A. and other countries. All rights reserved. All other trademarks mentioned herein are the property of their respective companies.
DS30292A-page 200